SemaOverload.cpp revision 49f4e1cbd839da27ff4814b4ea6d85a79f786cbd
1//===--- SemaOverload.cpp - C++ Overloading ---------------------*- C++ -*-===// 2// 3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure 4// 5// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source 6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details. 7// 8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 9// 10// This file provides Sema routines for C++ overloading. 11// 12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 13 14#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h" 15#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h" 16#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h" 17#include "clang/Sema/Template.h" 18#include "clang/Sema/TemplateDeduction.h" 19#include "clang/Basic/Diagnostic.h" 20#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h" 21#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h" 22#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h" 23#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h" 24#include "clang/AST/Expr.h" 25#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h" 26#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h" 27#include "clang/AST/TypeOrdering.h" 28#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h" 29#include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h" 30#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h" 31#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h" 32#include <algorithm> 33 34namespace clang { 35using namespace sema; 36 37/// A convenience routine for creating a decayed reference to a 38/// function. 39static Expr * 40CreateFunctionRefExpr(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn, 41 SourceLocation Loc = SourceLocation()) { 42 Expr *E = new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Fn, Fn->getType(), VK_LValue, Loc); 43 S.DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E); 44 return E; 45} 46 47static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType, 48 bool InOverloadResolution, 49 StandardConversionSequence &SCS); 50static OverloadingResult 51IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 52 UserDefinedConversionSequence& User, 53 OverloadCandidateSet& Conversions, 54 bool AllowExplicit); 55 56 57static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 58CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S, 59 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 60 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2); 61 62static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 63CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S, 64 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 65 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2); 66 67static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 68CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S, 69 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 70 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2); 71 72 73 74/// GetConversionCategory - Retrieve the implicit conversion 75/// category corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind. 76ImplicitConversionCategory 77GetConversionCategory(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) { 78 static const ImplicitConversionCategory 79 Category[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = { 80 ICC_Identity, 81 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation, 82 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation, 83 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation, 84 ICC_Identity, 85 ICC_Qualification_Adjustment, 86 ICC_Promotion, 87 ICC_Promotion, 88 ICC_Promotion, 89 ICC_Conversion, 90 ICC_Conversion, 91 ICC_Conversion, 92 ICC_Conversion, 93 ICC_Conversion, 94 ICC_Conversion, 95 ICC_Conversion, 96 ICC_Conversion, 97 ICC_Conversion, 98 ICC_Conversion, 99 ICC_Conversion, 100 ICC_Conversion 101 }; 102 return Category[(int)Kind]; 103} 104 105/// GetConversionRank - Retrieve the implicit conversion rank 106/// corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind. 107ImplicitConversionRank GetConversionRank(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) { 108 static const ImplicitConversionRank 109 Rank[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = { 110 ICR_Exact_Match, 111 ICR_Exact_Match, 112 ICR_Exact_Match, 113 ICR_Exact_Match, 114 ICR_Exact_Match, 115 ICR_Exact_Match, 116 ICR_Promotion, 117 ICR_Promotion, 118 ICR_Promotion, 119 ICR_Conversion, 120 ICR_Conversion, 121 ICR_Conversion, 122 ICR_Conversion, 123 ICR_Conversion, 124 ICR_Conversion, 125 ICR_Conversion, 126 ICR_Conversion, 127 ICR_Conversion, 128 ICR_Conversion, 129 ICR_Conversion, 130 ICR_Complex_Real_Conversion 131 }; 132 return Rank[(int)Kind]; 133} 134 135/// GetImplicitConversionName - Return the name of this kind of 136/// implicit conversion. 137const char* GetImplicitConversionName(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) { 138 static const char* const Name[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = { 139 "No conversion", 140 "Lvalue-to-rvalue", 141 "Array-to-pointer", 142 "Function-to-pointer", 143 "Noreturn adjustment", 144 "Qualification", 145 "Integral promotion", 146 "Floating point promotion", 147 "Complex promotion", 148 "Integral conversion", 149 "Floating conversion", 150 "Complex conversion", 151 "Floating-integral conversion", 152 "Pointer conversion", 153 "Pointer-to-member conversion", 154 "Boolean conversion", 155 "Compatible-types conversion", 156 "Derived-to-base conversion", 157 "Vector conversion", 158 "Vector splat", 159 "Complex-real conversion" 160 }; 161 return Name[Kind]; 162} 163 164/// StandardConversionSequence - Set the standard conversion 165/// sequence to the identity conversion. 166void StandardConversionSequence::setAsIdentityConversion() { 167 First = ICK_Identity; 168 Second = ICK_Identity; 169 Third = ICK_Identity; 170 DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false; 171 ReferenceBinding = false; 172 DirectBinding = false; 173 RRefBinding = false; 174 CopyConstructor = 0; 175} 176 177/// getRank - Retrieve the rank of this standard conversion sequence 178/// (C++ 13.3.3.1.1p3). The rank is the largest rank of each of the 179/// implicit conversions. 180ImplicitConversionRank StandardConversionSequence::getRank() const { 181 ImplicitConversionRank Rank = ICR_Exact_Match; 182 if (GetConversionRank(First) > Rank) 183 Rank = GetConversionRank(First); 184 if (GetConversionRank(Second) > Rank) 185 Rank = GetConversionRank(Second); 186 if (GetConversionRank(Third) > Rank) 187 Rank = GetConversionRank(Third); 188 return Rank; 189} 190 191/// isPointerConversionToBool - Determines whether this conversion is 192/// a conversion of a pointer or pointer-to-member to bool. This is 193/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences 194/// (C++ 13.3.3.2p4). 195bool StandardConversionSequence::isPointerConversionToBool() const { 196 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the 197 // array-to-pointer or function-to-pointer implicit conversions, so 198 // check for their presence as well as checking whether FromType is 199 // a pointer. 200 if (getToType(1)->isBooleanType() && 201 (getFromType()->isPointerType() || 202 getFromType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() || 203 getFromType()->isBlockPointerType() || 204 getFromType()->isNullPtrType() || 205 First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer || First == ICK_Function_To_Pointer)) 206 return true; 207 208 return false; 209} 210 211/// isPointerConversionToVoidPointer - Determines whether this 212/// conversion is a conversion of a pointer to a void pointer. This is 213/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences (C++ 214/// 13.3.3.2p4). 215bool 216StandardConversionSequence:: 217isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(ASTContext& Context) const { 218 QualType FromType = getFromType(); 219 QualType ToType = getToType(1); 220 221 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the 222 // array-to-pointer implicit conversion, so check for its presence 223 // and redo the conversion to get a pointer. 224 if (First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 225 FromType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType); 226 227 if (Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && FromType->isPointerType()) 228 if (const PointerType* ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) 229 return ToPtrType->getPointeeType()->isVoidType(); 230 231 return false; 232} 233 234/// DebugPrint - Print this standard conversion sequence to standard 235/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues. 236void StandardConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const { 237 llvm::raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs(); 238 bool PrintedSomething = false; 239 if (First != ICK_Identity) { 240 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(First); 241 PrintedSomething = true; 242 } 243 244 if (Second != ICK_Identity) { 245 if (PrintedSomething) { 246 OS << " -> "; 247 } 248 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Second); 249 250 if (CopyConstructor) { 251 OS << " (by copy constructor)"; 252 } else if (DirectBinding) { 253 OS << " (direct reference binding)"; 254 } else if (ReferenceBinding) { 255 OS << " (reference binding)"; 256 } 257 PrintedSomething = true; 258 } 259 260 if (Third != ICK_Identity) { 261 if (PrintedSomething) { 262 OS << " -> "; 263 } 264 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Third); 265 PrintedSomething = true; 266 } 267 268 if (!PrintedSomething) { 269 OS << "No conversions required"; 270 } 271} 272 273/// DebugPrint - Print this user-defined conversion sequence to standard 274/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues. 275void UserDefinedConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const { 276 llvm::raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs(); 277 if (Before.First || Before.Second || Before.Third) { 278 Before.DebugPrint(); 279 OS << " -> "; 280 } 281 OS << '\'' << ConversionFunction << '\''; 282 if (After.First || After.Second || After.Third) { 283 OS << " -> "; 284 After.DebugPrint(); 285 } 286} 287 288/// DebugPrint - Print this implicit conversion sequence to standard 289/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues. 290void ImplicitConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const { 291 llvm::raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs(); 292 switch (ConversionKind) { 293 case StandardConversion: 294 OS << "Standard conversion: "; 295 Standard.DebugPrint(); 296 break; 297 case UserDefinedConversion: 298 OS << "User-defined conversion: "; 299 UserDefined.DebugPrint(); 300 break; 301 case EllipsisConversion: 302 OS << "Ellipsis conversion"; 303 break; 304 case AmbiguousConversion: 305 OS << "Ambiguous conversion"; 306 break; 307 case BadConversion: 308 OS << "Bad conversion"; 309 break; 310 } 311 312 OS << "\n"; 313} 314 315void AmbiguousConversionSequence::construct() { 316 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(); 317} 318 319void AmbiguousConversionSequence::destruct() { 320 conversions().~ConversionSet(); 321} 322 323void 324AmbiguousConversionSequence::copyFrom(const AmbiguousConversionSequence &O) { 325 FromTypePtr = O.FromTypePtr; 326 ToTypePtr = O.ToTypePtr; 327 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(O.conversions()); 328} 329 330namespace { 331 // Structure used by OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo to store 332 // template parameter and template argument information. 333 struct DFIParamWithArguments { 334 TemplateParameter Param; 335 TemplateArgument FirstArg; 336 TemplateArgument SecondArg; 337 }; 338} 339 340/// \brief Convert from Sema's representation of template deduction information 341/// to the form used in overload-candidate information. 342OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo 343static MakeDeductionFailureInfo(ASTContext &Context, 344 Sema::TemplateDeductionResult TDK, 345 TemplateDeductionInfo &Info) { 346 OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo Result; 347 Result.Result = static_cast<unsigned>(TDK); 348 Result.Data = 0; 349 switch (TDK) { 350 case Sema::TDK_Success: 351 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 352 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 353 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 354 break; 355 356 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 357 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 358 Result.Data = Info.Param.getOpaqueValue(); 359 break; 360 361 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 362 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: { 363 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later. 364 DFIParamWithArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIParamWithArguments; 365 Saved->Param = Info.Param; 366 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg; 367 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg; 368 Result.Data = Saved; 369 break; 370 } 371 372 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 373 Result.Data = Info.take(); 374 break; 375 376 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 377 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution: 378 break; 379 } 380 381 return Result; 382} 383 384void OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::Destroy() { 385 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 386 case Sema::TDK_Success: 387 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 388 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 389 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 390 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 391 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 392 break; 393 394 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 395 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 396 // FIXME: Destroy the data? 397 Data = 0; 398 break; 399 400 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 401 // FIXME: Destroy the template arugment list? 402 Data = 0; 403 break; 404 405 // Unhandled 406 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 407 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution: 408 break; 409 } 410} 411 412TemplateParameter 413OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateParameter() { 414 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 415 case Sema::TDK_Success: 416 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 417 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 418 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 419 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 420 return TemplateParameter(); 421 422 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 423 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 424 return TemplateParameter::getFromOpaqueValue(Data); 425 426 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 427 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 428 return static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->Param; 429 430 // Unhandled 431 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 432 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution: 433 break; 434 } 435 436 return TemplateParameter(); 437} 438 439TemplateArgumentList * 440OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateArgumentList() { 441 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 442 case Sema::TDK_Success: 443 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 444 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 445 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 446 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 447 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 448 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 449 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 450 return 0; 451 452 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 453 return static_cast<TemplateArgumentList*>(Data); 454 455 // Unhandled 456 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 457 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution: 458 break; 459 } 460 461 return 0; 462} 463 464const TemplateArgument *OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getFirstArg() { 465 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 466 case Sema::TDK_Success: 467 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 468 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 469 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 470 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 471 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 472 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 473 return 0; 474 475 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 476 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 477 return &static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->FirstArg; 478 479 // Unhandled 480 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 481 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution: 482 break; 483 } 484 485 return 0; 486} 487 488const TemplateArgument * 489OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getSecondArg() { 490 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 491 case Sema::TDK_Success: 492 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 493 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 494 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 495 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 496 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 497 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 498 return 0; 499 500 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 501 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 502 return &static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->SecondArg; 503 504 // Unhandled 505 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 506 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution: 507 break; 508 } 509 510 return 0; 511} 512 513void OverloadCandidateSet::clear() { 514 inherited::clear(); 515 Functions.clear(); 516} 517 518// IsOverload - Determine whether the given New declaration is an 519// overload of the declarations in Old. This routine returns false if 520// New and Old cannot be overloaded, e.g., if New has the same 521// signature as some function in Old (C++ 1.3.10) or if the Old 522// declarations aren't functions (or function templates) at all. When 523// it does return false, MatchedDecl will point to the decl that New 524// cannot be overloaded with. This decl may be a UsingShadowDecl on 525// top of the underlying declaration. 526// 527// Example: Given the following input: 528// 529// void f(int, float); // #1 530// void f(int, int); // #2 531// int f(int, int); // #3 532// 533// When we process #1, there is no previous declaration of "f", 534// so IsOverload will not be used. 535// 536// When we process #2, Old contains only the FunctionDecl for #1. By 537// comparing the parameter types, we see that #1 and #2 are overloaded 538// (since they have different signatures), so this routine returns 539// false; MatchedDecl is unchanged. 540// 541// When we process #3, Old is an overload set containing #1 and #2. We 542// compare the signatures of #3 to #1 (they're overloaded, so we do 543// nothing) and then #3 to #2. Since the signatures of #3 and #2 are 544// identical (return types of functions are not part of the 545// signature), IsOverload returns false and MatchedDecl will be set to 546// point to the FunctionDecl for #2. 547// 548// 'NewIsUsingShadowDecl' indicates that 'New' is being introduced 549// into a class by a using declaration. The rules for whether to hide 550// shadow declarations ignore some properties which otherwise figure 551// into a function template's signature. 552Sema::OverloadKind 553Sema::CheckOverload(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *New, const LookupResult &Old, 554 NamedDecl *&Match, bool NewIsUsingDecl) { 555 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Old.begin(), E = Old.end(); 556 I != E; ++I) { 557 NamedDecl *OldD = *I; 558 559 bool OldIsUsingDecl = false; 560 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) { 561 OldIsUsingDecl = true; 562 563 // We can always introduce two using declarations into the same 564 // context, even if they have identical signatures. 565 if (NewIsUsingDecl) continue; 566 567 OldD = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)->getTargetDecl(); 568 } 569 570 // If either declaration was introduced by a using declaration, 571 // we'll need to use slightly different rules for matching. 572 // Essentially, these rules are the normal rules, except that 573 // function templates hide function templates with different 574 // return types or template parameter lists. 575 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules = 576 (OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && CurContext->isRecord(); 577 578 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *OldT = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldD)) { 579 if (!IsOverload(New, OldT->getTemplatedDecl(), UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) { 580 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) { 581 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I)); 582 continue; 583 } 584 585 Match = *I; 586 return Ovl_Match; 587 } 588 } else if (FunctionDecl *OldF = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(OldD)) { 589 if (!IsOverload(New, OldF, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) { 590 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) { 591 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I)); 592 continue; 593 } 594 595 Match = *I; 596 return Ovl_Match; 597 } 598 } else if (isa<UsingDecl>(OldD)) { 599 // We can overload with these, which can show up when doing 600 // redeclaration checks for UsingDecls. 601 assert(Old.getLookupKind() == LookupUsingDeclName); 602 } else if (isa<TagDecl>(OldD)) { 603 // We can always overload with tags by hiding them. 604 } else if (isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(OldD)) { 605 // Optimistically assume that an unresolved using decl will 606 // overload; if it doesn't, we'll have to diagnose during 607 // template instantiation. 608 } else { 609 // (C++ 13p1): 610 // Only function declarations can be overloaded; object and type 611 // declarations cannot be overloaded. 612 Match = *I; 613 return Ovl_NonFunction; 614 } 615 } 616 617 return Ovl_Overload; 618} 619 620bool Sema::IsOverload(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old, 621 bool UseUsingDeclRules) { 622 // If both of the functions are extern "C", then they are not 623 // overloads. 624 if (Old->isExternC() && New->isExternC()) 625 return false; 626 627 FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = Old->getDescribedFunctionTemplate(); 628 FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate(); 629 630 // C++ [temp.fct]p2: 631 // A function template can be overloaded with other function templates 632 // and with normal (non-template) functions. 633 if ((OldTemplate == 0) != (NewTemplate == 0)) 634 return true; 635 636 // Is the function New an overload of the function Old? 637 QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType()); 638 QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType()); 639 640 // Compare the signatures (C++ 1.3.10) of the two functions to 641 // determine whether they are overloads. If we find any mismatch 642 // in the signature, they are overloads. 643 644 // If either of these functions is a K&R-style function (no 645 // prototype), then we consider them to have matching signatures. 646 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(OldQType.getTypePtr()) || 647 isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewQType.getTypePtr())) 648 return false; 649 650 FunctionProtoType* OldType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldQType); 651 FunctionProtoType* NewType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(NewQType); 652 653 // The signature of a function includes the types of its 654 // parameters (C++ 1.3.10), which includes the presence or absence 655 // of the ellipsis; see C++ DR 357). 656 if (OldQType != NewQType && 657 (OldType->getNumArgs() != NewType->getNumArgs() || 658 OldType->isVariadic() != NewType->isVariadic() || 659 !FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(OldType, NewType))) 660 return true; 661 662 // C++ [temp.over.link]p4: 663 // The signature of a function template consists of its function 664 // signature, its return type and its template parameter list. The names 665 // of the template parameters are significant only for establishing the 666 // relationship between the template parameters and the rest of the 667 // signature. 668 // 669 // We check the return type and template parameter lists for function 670 // templates first; the remaining checks follow. 671 // 672 // However, we don't consider either of these when deciding whether 673 // a member introduced by a shadow declaration is hidden. 674 if (!UseUsingDeclRules && NewTemplate && 675 (!TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(), 676 OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(), 677 false, TPL_TemplateMatch) || 678 OldType->getResultType() != NewType->getResultType())) 679 return true; 680 681 // If the function is a class member, its signature includes the 682 // cv-qualifiers (if any) on the function itself. 683 // 684 // As part of this, also check whether one of the member functions 685 // is static, in which case they are not overloads (C++ 686 // 13.1p2). While not part of the definition of the signature, 687 // this check is important to determine whether these functions 688 // can be overloaded. 689 CXXMethodDecl* OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old); 690 CXXMethodDecl* NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New); 691 if (OldMethod && NewMethod && 692 !OldMethod->isStatic() && !NewMethod->isStatic() && 693 OldMethod->getTypeQualifiers() != NewMethod->getTypeQualifiers()) 694 return true; 695 696 // The signatures match; this is not an overload. 697 return false; 698} 699 700/// TryImplicitConversion - Attempt to perform an implicit conversion 701/// from the given expression (Expr) to the given type (ToType). This 702/// function returns an implicit conversion sequence that can be used 703/// to perform the initialization. Given 704/// 705/// void f(float f); 706/// void g(int i) { f(i); } 707/// 708/// this routine would produce an implicit conversion sequence to 709/// describe the initialization of f from i, which will be a standard 710/// conversion sequence containing an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++ 711/// 4.1) followed by a floating-integral conversion (C++ 4.9). 712// 713/// Note that this routine only determines how the conversion can be 714/// performed; it does not actually perform the conversion. As such, 715/// it will not produce any diagnostics if no conversion is available, 716/// but will instead return an implicit conversion sequence of kind 717/// "BadConversion". 718/// 719/// If @p SuppressUserConversions, then user-defined conversions are 720/// not permitted. 721/// If @p AllowExplicit, then explicit user-defined conversions are 722/// permitted. 723static ImplicitConversionSequence 724TryImplicitConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 725 bool SuppressUserConversions, 726 bool AllowExplicit, 727 bool InOverloadResolution) { 728 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 729 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution, 730 ICS.Standard)) { 731 ICS.setStandard(); 732 return ICS; 733 } 734 735 if (!S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) { 736 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType); 737 return ICS; 738 } 739 740 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4: 741 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class 742 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an 743 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is 744 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy/move 745 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is 746 // called for those cases. 747 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 748 if (ToType->getAs<RecordType>() && FromType->getAs<RecordType>() && 749 (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType) || 750 S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ToType))) { 751 ICS.setStandard(); 752 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 753 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType); 754 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 755 756 // We don't actually check at this point whether there is a valid 757 // copy/move constructor, since overloading just assumes that it 758 // exists. When we actually perform initialization, we'll find the 759 // appropriate constructor to copy the returned object, if needed. 760 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0; 761 762 // Determine whether this is considered a derived-to-base conversion. 763 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) 764 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base; 765 766 return ICS; 767 } 768 769 if (SuppressUserConversions) { 770 // We're not in the case above, so there is no conversion that 771 // we can perform. 772 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType); 773 return ICS; 774 } 775 776 // Attempt user-defined conversion. 777 OverloadCandidateSet Conversions(From->getExprLoc()); 778 OverloadingResult UserDefResult 779 = IsUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined, Conversions, 780 AllowExplicit); 781 782 if (UserDefResult == OR_Success) { 783 ICS.setUserDefined(); 784 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4: 785 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class 786 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an 787 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is 788 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy 789 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is 790 // called for those cases. 791 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor 792 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)) { 793 QualType FromCanon 794 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType()); 795 QualType ToCanon 796 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType(); 797 if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor() && 798 (FromCanon == ToCanon || S.IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon))) { 799 // Turn this into a "standard" conversion sequence, so that it 800 // gets ranked with standard conversion sequences. 801 ICS.setStandard(); 802 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 803 ICS.Standard.setFromType(From->getType()); 804 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 805 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = Constructor; 806 if (ToCanon != FromCanon) 807 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base; 808 } 809 } 810 811 // C++ [over.best.ics]p4: 812 // However, when considering the argument of a user-defined 813 // conversion function that is a candidate by 13.3.1.3 when 814 // invoked for the copying of the temporary in the second step 815 // of a class copy-initialization, or by 13.3.1.4, 13.3.1.5, or 816 // 13.3.1.6 in all cases, only standard conversion sequences and 817 // ellipsis conversion sequences are allowed. 818 if (SuppressUserConversions && ICS.isUserDefined()) { 819 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::suppressed_user, From, ToType); 820 } 821 } else if (UserDefResult == OR_Ambiguous && !SuppressUserConversions) { 822 ICS.setAmbiguous(); 823 ICS.Ambiguous.setFromType(From->getType()); 824 ICS.Ambiguous.setToType(ToType); 825 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = Conversions.begin(); 826 Cand != Conversions.end(); ++Cand) 827 if (Cand->Viable) 828 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function); 829 } else { 830 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType); 831 } 832 833 return ICS; 834} 835 836bool Sema::TryImplicitConversion(InitializationSequence &Sequence, 837 const InitializedEntity &Entity, 838 Expr *Initializer, 839 bool SuppressUserConversions, 840 bool AllowExplicitConversions, 841 bool InOverloadResolution) { 842 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS 843 = clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, Initializer, Entity.getType(), 844 SuppressUserConversions, 845 AllowExplicitConversions, 846 InOverloadResolution); 847 if (ICS.isBad()) return true; 848 849 // Perform the actual conversion. 850 Sequence.AddConversionSequenceStep(ICS, Entity.getType()); 851 return false; 852} 853 854/// PerformImplicitConversion - Perform an implicit conversion of the 855/// expression From to the type ToType. Returns true if there was an 856/// error, false otherwise. The expression From is replaced with the 857/// converted expression. Flavor is the kind of conversion we're 858/// performing, used in the error message. If @p AllowExplicit, 859/// explicit user-defined conversions are permitted. 860bool 861Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *&From, QualType ToType, 862 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit) { 863 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 864 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, Action, AllowExplicit, ICS); 865} 866 867bool 868Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *&From, QualType ToType, 869 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit, 870 ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS) { 871 ICS = clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType, 872 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 873 AllowExplicit, 874 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false); 875 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, ICS, Action); 876} 877 878/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid 879/// conversion that strips "noreturn" off the nested function type. 880static bool IsNoReturnConversion(ASTContext &Context, QualType FromType, 881 QualType ToType, QualType &ResultTy) { 882 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) 883 return false; 884 885 // Strip the noreturn off the type we're converting from; noreturn can 886 // safely be removed. 887 FromType = Context.getNoReturnType(FromType, false); 888 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) 889 return false; 890 891 ResultTy = FromType; 892 return true; 893} 894 895/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid 896/// vector conversion. 897/// 898/// \param ICK Will be set to the vector conversion kind, if this is a vector 899/// conversion. 900static bool IsVectorConversion(ASTContext &Context, QualType FromType, 901 QualType ToType, ImplicitConversionKind &ICK) { 902 // We need at least one of these types to be a vector type to have a vector 903 // conversion. 904 if (!ToType->isVectorType() && !FromType->isVectorType()) 905 return false; 906 907 // Identical types require no conversions. 908 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) 909 return false; 910 911 // There are no conversions between extended vector types, only identity. 912 if (ToType->isExtVectorType()) { 913 // There are no conversions between extended vector types other than the 914 // identity conversion. 915 if (FromType->isExtVectorType()) 916 return false; 917 918 // Vector splat from any arithmetic type to a vector. 919 if (FromType->isArithmeticType()) { 920 ICK = ICK_Vector_Splat; 921 return true; 922 } 923 } 924 925 // We can perform the conversion between vector types in the following cases: 926 // 1)vector types are equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types 927 // 2)lax vector conversions are permitted and the vector types are of the 928 // same size 929 if (ToType->isVectorType() && FromType->isVectorType()) { 930 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromType, ToType) || 931 (Context.getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions && 932 (Context.getTypeSize(FromType) == Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) { 933 ICK = ICK_Vector_Conversion; 934 return true; 935 } 936 } 937 938 return false; 939} 940 941/// IsStandardConversion - Determines whether there is a standard 942/// conversion sequence (C++ [conv], C++ [over.ics.scs]) from the 943/// expression From to the type ToType. Standard conversion sequences 944/// only consider non-class types; for conversions that involve class 945/// types, use TryImplicitConversion. If a conversion exists, SCS will 946/// contain the standard conversion sequence required to perform this 947/// conversion and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this 948/// routine will return false and the value of SCS is unspecified. 949static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType, 950 bool InOverloadResolution, 951 StandardConversionSequence &SCS) { 952 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 953 954 // Standard conversions (C++ [conv]) 955 SCS.setAsIdentityConversion(); 956 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false; 957 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = false; 958 SCS.setFromType(FromType); 959 SCS.CopyConstructor = 0; 960 961 // There are no standard conversions for class types in C++, so 962 // abort early. When overloading in C, however, we do permit 963 if (FromType->isRecordType() || ToType->isRecordType()) { 964 if (S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) 965 return false; 966 967 // When we're overloading in C, we allow, as standard conversions, 968 } 969 970 // The first conversion can be an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, 971 // array-to-pointer conversion, or function-to-pointer conversion 972 // (C++ 4p1). 973 974 if (FromType == S.Context.OverloadTy) { 975 DeclAccessPair AccessPair; 976 if (FunctionDecl *Fn 977 = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(From, ToType, false, 978 AccessPair)) { 979 // We were able to resolve the address of the overloaded function, 980 // so we can convert to the type of that function. 981 FromType = Fn->getType(); 982 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) { 983 if (!Method->isStatic()) { 984 Type *ClassType 985 = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(Method->getParent()).getTypePtr(); 986 FromType = S.Context.getMemberPointerType(FromType, ClassType); 987 } 988 } 989 990 // If the "from" expression takes the address of the overloaded 991 // function, update the type of the resulting expression accordingly. 992 if (FromType->getAs<FunctionType>()) 993 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())) 994 if (UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf) 995 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType); 996 997 // Check that we've computed the proper type after overload resolution. 998 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(FromType, 999 S.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(From, AccessPair, Fn)->getType())); 1000 } else { 1001 return false; 1002 } 1003 } 1004 // Lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++ 4.1): 1005 // An lvalue (3.10) of a non-function, non-array type T can be 1006 // converted to an rvalue. 1007 bool argIsLValue = From->isLValue(); 1008 if (argIsLValue && 1009 !FromType->isFunctionType() && !FromType->isArrayType() && 1010 S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType) != S.Context.OverloadTy) { 1011 SCS.First = ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue; 1012 1013 // If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the 1014 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the rvalue 1015 // is T (C++ 4.1p1). C++ can't get here with class types; in C, we 1016 // just strip the qualifiers because they don't matter. 1017 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1018 } else if (FromType->isArrayType()) { 1019 // Array-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.2) 1020 SCS.First = ICK_Array_To_Pointer; 1021 1022 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown 1023 // bound of T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to 1024 // T" (C++ 4.2p1). 1025 FromType = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType); 1026 1027 if (S.IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(From, ToType)) { 1028 // This conversion is deprecated. (C++ D.4). 1029 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = true; 1030 1031 // For the purpose of ranking in overload resolution 1032 // (13.3.3.1.1), this conversion is considered an 1033 // array-to-pointer conversion followed by a qualification 1034 // conversion (4.4). (C++ 4.2p2) 1035 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity; 1036 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification; 1037 SCS.setAllToTypes(FromType); 1038 return true; 1039 } 1040 } else if (FromType->isFunctionType() && argIsLValue) { 1041 // Function-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.3). 1042 SCS.First = ICK_Function_To_Pointer; 1043 1044 // An lvalue of function type T can be converted to an rvalue of 1045 // type "pointer to T." The result is a pointer to the 1046 // function. (C++ 4.3p1). 1047 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType); 1048 } else { 1049 // We don't require any conversions for the first step. 1050 SCS.First = ICK_Identity; 1051 } 1052 SCS.setToType(0, FromType); 1053 1054 // The second conversion can be an integral promotion, floating 1055 // point promotion, integral conversion, floating point conversion, 1056 // floating-integral conversion, pointer conversion, 1057 // pointer-to-member conversion, or boolean conversion (C++ 4p1). 1058 // For overloading in C, this can also be a "compatible-type" 1059 // conversion. 1060 bool IncompatibleObjC = false; 1061 ImplicitConversionKind SecondICK = ICK_Identity; 1062 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) { 1063 // The unqualified versions of the types are the same: there's no 1064 // conversion to do. 1065 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity; 1066 } else if (S.IsIntegralPromotion(From, FromType, ToType)) { 1067 // Integral promotion (C++ 4.5). 1068 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Promotion; 1069 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1070 } else if (S.IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromType, ToType)) { 1071 // Floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). 1072 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Promotion; 1073 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1074 } else if (S.IsComplexPromotion(FromType, ToType)) { 1075 // Complex promotion (Clang extension) 1076 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Promotion; 1077 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1078 } else if (ToType->isBooleanType() && 1079 (FromType->isArithmeticType() || 1080 FromType->isAnyPointerType() || 1081 FromType->isBlockPointerType() || 1082 FromType->isMemberPointerType() || 1083 FromType->isNullPtrType())) { 1084 // Boolean conversions (C++ 4.12). 1085 SCS.Second = ICK_Boolean_Conversion; 1086 FromType = S.Context.BoolTy; 1087 } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() && 1088 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) { 1089 // Integral conversions (C++ 4.7). 1090 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Conversion; 1091 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1092 } else if (FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isComplexType()) { 1093 // Complex conversions (C99 6.3.1.6) 1094 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Conversion; 1095 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1096 } else if ((FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isArithmeticType()) || 1097 (ToType->isAnyComplexType() && FromType->isArithmeticType())) { 1098 // Complex-real conversions (C99 6.3.1.7) 1099 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Real; 1100 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1101 } else if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) { 1102 // Floating point conversions (C++ 4.8). 1103 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Conversion; 1104 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1105 } else if ((FromType->isRealFloatingType() && 1106 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) || 1107 (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() && 1108 ToType->isRealFloatingType())) { 1109 // Floating-integral conversions (C++ 4.9). 1110 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Integral; 1111 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1112 } else if (S.IsPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, InOverloadResolution, 1113 FromType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 1114 // Pointer conversions (C++ 4.10). 1115 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Conversion; 1116 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = IncompatibleObjC; 1117 } else if (S.IsMemberPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, 1118 InOverloadResolution, FromType)) { 1119 // Pointer to member conversions (4.11). 1120 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Member; 1121 } else if (IsVectorConversion(S.Context, FromType, ToType, SecondICK)) { 1122 SCS.Second = SecondICK; 1123 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1124 } else if (!S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && 1125 S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType)) { 1126 // Compatible conversions (Clang extension for C function overloading) 1127 SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion; 1128 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1129 } else if (IsNoReturnConversion(S.Context, FromType, ToType, FromType)) { 1130 // Treat a conversion that strips "noreturn" as an identity conversion. 1131 SCS.Second = ICK_NoReturn_Adjustment; 1132 } else { 1133 // No second conversion required. 1134 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity; 1135 } 1136 SCS.setToType(1, FromType); 1137 1138 QualType CanonFrom; 1139 QualType CanonTo; 1140 // The third conversion can be a qualification conversion (C++ 4p1). 1141 if (S.IsQualificationConversion(FromType, ToType)) { 1142 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification; 1143 FromType = ToType; 1144 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 1145 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType); 1146 } else { 1147 // No conversion required 1148 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity; 1149 1150 // C++ [over.best.ics]p6: 1151 // [...] Any difference in top-level cv-qualification is 1152 // subsumed by the initialization itself and does not constitute 1153 // a conversion. [...] 1154 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 1155 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType); 1156 if (CanonFrom.getLocalUnqualifiedType() 1157 == CanonTo.getLocalUnqualifiedType() && 1158 (CanonFrom.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != CanonTo.getLocalCVRQualifiers() 1159 || CanonFrom.getObjCGCAttr() != CanonTo.getObjCGCAttr())) { 1160 FromType = ToType; 1161 CanonFrom = CanonTo; 1162 } 1163 } 1164 SCS.setToType(2, FromType); 1165 1166 // If we have not converted the argument type to the parameter type, 1167 // this is a bad conversion sequence. 1168 if (CanonFrom != CanonTo) 1169 return false; 1170 1171 return true; 1172} 1173 1174/// IsIntegralPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from the 1175/// expression From (whose potentially-adjusted type is FromType) to 1176/// ToType is an integral promotion (C++ 4.5). If so, returns true and 1177/// sets PromotedType to the promoted type. 1178bool Sema::IsIntegralPromotion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType) { 1179 const BuiltinType *To = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>(); 1180 // All integers are built-in. 1181 if (!To) { 1182 return false; 1183 } 1184 1185 // An rvalue of type char, signed char, unsigned char, short int, or 1186 // unsigned short int can be converted to an rvalue of type int if 1187 // int can represent all the values of the source type; otherwise, 1188 // the source rvalue can be converted to an rvalue of type unsigned 1189 // int (C++ 4.5p1). 1190 if (FromType->isPromotableIntegerType() && !FromType->isBooleanType() && 1191 !FromType->isEnumeralType()) { 1192 if (// We can promote any signed, promotable integer type to an int 1193 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() || 1194 // We can promote any unsigned integer type whose size is 1195 // less than int to an int. 1196 (!FromType->isSignedIntegerType() && 1197 Context.getTypeSize(FromType) < Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) { 1198 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int; 1199 } 1200 1201 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt; 1202 } 1203 1204 // C++0x [conv.prom]p3: 1205 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is not 1206 // fixed (7.2) can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the 1207 // following types that can represent all the values of the enumeration 1208 // (i.e., the values in the range bmin to bmax as described in 7.2): int, 1209 // unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned 1210 // long long int. If none of the types in that list can represent all the 1211 // values of the enumeration, an rvalue a prvalue of an unscoped enumeration 1212 // type can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the extended integer type 1213 // with lowest integer conversion rank (4.13) greater than the rank of long 1214 // long in which all the values of the enumeration can be represented. If 1215 // there are two such extended types, the signed one is chosen. 1216 if (const EnumType *FromEnumType = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()) { 1217 // C++0x 7.2p9: Note that this implicit enum to int conversion is not 1218 // provided for a scoped enumeration. 1219 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isScoped()) 1220 return false; 1221 1222 // We have already pre-calculated the promotion type, so this is trivial. 1223 if (ToType->isIntegerType() && 1224 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromType, PDiag())) 1225 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, 1226 FromEnumType->getDecl()->getPromotionType()); 1227 } 1228 1229 // C++0x [conv.prom]p2: 1230 // A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t (3.9.1) can be converted 1231 // to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the following types that can 1232 // represent all the values of its underlying type: int, unsigned int, 1233 // long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned long long int. 1234 // If none of the types in that list can represent all the values of its 1235 // underlying type, an rvalue a prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, 1236 // or wchar_t can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of its underlying 1237 // type. 1238 if (FromType->isAnyCharacterType() && !FromType->isCharType() && 1239 ToType->isIntegerType()) { 1240 // Determine whether the type we're converting from is signed or 1241 // unsigned. 1242 bool FromIsSigned; 1243 uint64_t FromSize = Context.getTypeSize(FromType); 1244 1245 // FIXME: Is wchar_t signed or unsigned? We assume it's signed for now. 1246 FromIsSigned = true; 1247 1248 // The types we'll try to promote to, in the appropriate 1249 // order. Try each of these types. 1250 QualType PromoteTypes[6] = { 1251 Context.IntTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy, 1252 Context.LongTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy , 1253 Context.LongLongTy, Context.UnsignedLongLongTy 1254 }; 1255 for (int Idx = 0; Idx < 6; ++Idx) { 1256 uint64_t ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]); 1257 if (FromSize < ToSize || 1258 (FromSize == ToSize && 1259 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType())) { 1260 // We found the type that we can promote to. If this is the 1261 // type we wanted, we have a promotion. Otherwise, no 1262 // promotion. 1263 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, PromoteTypes[Idx]); 1264 } 1265 } 1266 } 1267 1268 // An rvalue for an integral bit-field (9.6) can be converted to an 1269 // rvalue of type int if int can represent all the values of the 1270 // bit-field; otherwise, it can be converted to unsigned int if 1271 // unsigned int can represent all the values of the bit-field. If 1272 // the bit-field is larger yet, no integral promotion applies to 1273 // it. If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any 1274 // other value of that type for promotion purposes (C++ 4.5p3). 1275 // FIXME: We should delay checking of bit-fields until we actually perform the 1276 // conversion. 1277 using llvm::APSInt; 1278 if (From) 1279 if (FieldDecl *MemberDecl = From->getBitField()) { 1280 APSInt BitWidth; 1281 if (FromType->isIntegralType(Context) && 1282 MemberDecl->getBitWidth()->isIntegerConstantExpr(BitWidth, Context)) { 1283 APSInt ToSize(BitWidth.getBitWidth(), BitWidth.isUnsigned()); 1284 ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(ToType); 1285 1286 // Are we promoting to an int from a bitfield that fits in an int? 1287 if (BitWidth < ToSize || 1288 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize)) { 1289 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int; 1290 } 1291 1292 // Are we promoting to an unsigned int from an unsigned bitfield 1293 // that fits into an unsigned int? 1294 if (FromType->isUnsignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize) { 1295 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt; 1296 } 1297 1298 return false; 1299 } 1300 } 1301 1302 // An rvalue of type bool can be converted to an rvalue of type int, 1303 // with false becoming zero and true becoming one (C++ 4.5p4). 1304 if (FromType->isBooleanType() && To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int) { 1305 return true; 1306 } 1307 1308 return false; 1309} 1310 1311/// IsFloatingPointPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from 1312/// FromType to ToType is a floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). If so, 1313/// returns true and sets PromotedType to the promoted type. 1314bool Sema::IsFloatingPointPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) { 1315 /// An rvalue of type float can be converted to an rvalue of type 1316 /// double. (C++ 4.6p1). 1317 if (const BuiltinType *FromBuiltin = FromType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) 1318 if (const BuiltinType *ToBuiltin = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) { 1319 if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float && 1320 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) 1321 return true; 1322 1323 // C99 6.3.1.5p1: 1324 // When a float is promoted to double or long double, or a 1325 // double is promoted to long double [...]. 1326 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && 1327 (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float || 1328 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) && 1329 (ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble)) 1330 return true; 1331 } 1332 1333 return false; 1334} 1335 1336/// \brief Determine if a conversion is a complex promotion. 1337/// 1338/// A complex promotion is defined as a complex -> complex conversion 1339/// where the conversion between the underlying real types is a 1340/// floating-point or integral promotion. 1341bool Sema::IsComplexPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) { 1342 const ComplexType *FromComplex = FromType->getAs<ComplexType>(); 1343 if (!FromComplex) 1344 return false; 1345 1346 const ComplexType *ToComplex = ToType->getAs<ComplexType>(); 1347 if (!ToComplex) 1348 return false; 1349 1350 return IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromComplex->getElementType(), 1351 ToComplex->getElementType()) || 1352 IsIntegralPromotion(0, FromComplex->getElementType(), 1353 ToComplex->getElementType()); 1354} 1355 1356/// BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType - In a pointer conversion from 1357/// the pointer type FromPtr to a pointer to type ToPointee, with the 1358/// same type qualifiers as FromPtr has on its pointee type. ToType, 1359/// if non-empty, will be a pointer to ToType that may or may not have 1360/// the right set of qualifiers on its pointee. 1361static QualType 1362BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(const Type *FromPtr, 1363 QualType ToPointee, QualType ToType, 1364 ASTContext &Context) { 1365 assert((FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::Pointer || 1366 FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::ObjCObjectPointer) && 1367 "Invalid similarly-qualified pointer type"); 1368 1369 /// \brief Conversions to 'id' subsume cv-qualifier conversions. 1370 if (ToType->isObjCIdType() || ToType->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) 1371 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1372 1373 QualType CanonFromPointee 1374 = Context.getCanonicalType(FromPtr->getPointeeType()); 1375 QualType CanonToPointee = Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointee); 1376 Qualifiers Quals = CanonFromPointee.getQualifiers(); 1377 1378 // Exact qualifier match -> return the pointer type we're converting to. 1379 if (CanonToPointee.getLocalQualifiers() == Quals) { 1380 // ToType is exactly what we need. Return it. 1381 if (!ToType.isNull()) 1382 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1383 1384 // Build a pointer to ToPointee. It has the right qualifiers 1385 // already. 1386 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType)) 1387 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(ToPointee); 1388 return Context.getPointerType(ToPointee); 1389 } 1390 1391 // Just build a canonical type that has the right qualifiers. 1392 QualType QualifiedCanonToPointee 1393 = Context.getQualifiedType(CanonToPointee.getLocalUnqualifiedType(), Quals); 1394 1395 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType)) 1396 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee); 1397 return Context.getPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee); 1398} 1399 1400static bool isNullPointerConstantForConversion(Expr *Expr, 1401 bool InOverloadResolution, 1402 ASTContext &Context) { 1403 // Handle value-dependent integral null pointer constants correctly. 1404 // http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#903 1405 if (Expr->isValueDependent() && !Expr->isTypeDependent() && 1406 Expr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !Expr->getType()->isEnumeralType()) 1407 return !InOverloadResolution; 1408 1409 return Expr->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 1410 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull 1411 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull); 1412} 1413 1414/// IsPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the 1415/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, 1416/// can be converted to the type ToType via a pointer conversion (C++ 1417/// 4.10). If so, returns true and places the converted type (that 1418/// might differ from ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into 1419/// ConvertedType. 1420/// 1421/// This routine also supports conversions to and from block pointers 1422/// and conversions with Objective-C's 'id', 'id<protocols...>', and 1423/// pointers to interfaces. FIXME: Once we've determined the 1424/// appropriate overloading rules for Objective-C, we may want to 1425/// split the Objective-C checks into a different routine; however, 1426/// GCC seems to consider all of these conversions to be pointer 1427/// conversions, so for now they live here. IncompatibleObjC will be 1428/// set if the conversion is an allowed Objective-C conversion that 1429/// should result in a warning. 1430bool Sema::IsPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 1431 bool InOverloadResolution, 1432 QualType& ConvertedType, 1433 bool &IncompatibleObjC) { 1434 IncompatibleObjC = false; 1435 if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) 1436 return true; 1437 1438 // Conversion from a null pointer constant to any Objective-C pointer type. 1439 if (ToType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 1440 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) { 1441 ConvertedType = ToType; 1442 return true; 1443 } 1444 1445 // Blocks: Block pointers can be converted to void*. 1446 if (FromType->isBlockPointerType() && ToType->isPointerType() && 1447 ToType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) { 1448 ConvertedType = ToType; 1449 return true; 1450 } 1451 // Blocks: A null pointer constant can be converted to a block 1452 // pointer type. 1453 if (ToType->isBlockPointerType() && 1454 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) { 1455 ConvertedType = ToType; 1456 return true; 1457 } 1458 1459 // If the left-hand-side is nullptr_t, the right side can be a null 1460 // pointer constant. 1461 if (ToType->isNullPtrType() && 1462 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) { 1463 ConvertedType = ToType; 1464 return true; 1465 } 1466 1467 const PointerType* ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>(); 1468 if (!ToTypePtr) 1469 return false; 1470 1471 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a pointer type (C++ 4.10p1). 1472 if (isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) { 1473 ConvertedType = ToType; 1474 return true; 1475 } 1476 1477 // Beyond this point, both types need to be pointers 1478 // , including objective-c pointers. 1479 QualType ToPointeeType = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 1480 if (FromType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) { 1481 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType( 1482 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(), 1483 ToPointeeType, 1484 ToType, Context); 1485 return true; 1486 } 1487 const PointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>(); 1488 if (!FromTypePtr) 1489 return false; 1490 1491 QualType FromPointeeType = FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 1492 1493 // If the unqualified pointee types are the same, this can't be a 1494 // pointer conversion, so don't do all of the work below. 1495 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) 1496 return false; 1497 1498 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv T," where T is an object type, 1499 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv void" (C++ 1500 // 4.10p2). 1501 if (FromPointeeType->isIncompleteOrObjectType() && 1502 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) { 1503 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 1504 ToPointeeType, 1505 ToType, Context); 1506 return true; 1507 } 1508 1509 // When we're overloading in C, we allow a special kind of pointer 1510 // conversion for compatible-but-not-identical pointee types. 1511 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && 1512 Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) { 1513 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 1514 ToPointeeType, 1515 ToType, Context); 1516 return true; 1517 } 1518 1519 // C++ [conv.ptr]p3: 1520 // 1521 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv D," where D is a class type, 1522 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv B," where 1523 // B is a base class (clause 10) of D. If B is an inaccessible 1524 // (clause 11) or ambiguous (10.2) base class of D, a program that 1525 // necessitates this conversion is ill-formed. The result of the 1526 // conversion is a pointer to the base class sub-object of the 1527 // derived class object. The null pointer value is converted to 1528 // the null pointer value of the destination type. 1529 // 1530 // Note that we do not check for ambiguity or inaccessibility 1531 // here. That is handled by CheckPointerConversion. 1532 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && 1533 FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() && 1534 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType) && 1535 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromPointeeType, PDiag()) && 1536 IsDerivedFrom(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) { 1537 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 1538 ToPointeeType, 1539 ToType, Context); 1540 return true; 1541 } 1542 1543 return false; 1544} 1545 1546/// isObjCPointerConversion - Determines whether this is an 1547/// Objective-C pointer conversion. Subroutine of IsPointerConversion, 1548/// with the same arguments and return values. 1549bool Sema::isObjCPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 1550 QualType& ConvertedType, 1551 bool &IncompatibleObjC) { 1552 if (!getLangOptions().ObjC1) 1553 return false; 1554 1555 // First, we handle all conversions on ObjC object pointer types. 1556 const ObjCObjectPointerType* ToObjCPtr = ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 1557 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromObjCPtr = 1558 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 1559 1560 if (ToObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr) { 1561 // If the pointee types are the same (ignoring qualifications), 1562 // then this is not a pointer conversion. 1563 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(), 1564 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType())) 1565 return false; 1566 1567 // Objective C++: We're able to convert between "id" or "Class" and a 1568 // pointer to any interface (in both directions). 1569 if (ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType() && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) { 1570 ConvertedType = ToType; 1571 return true; 1572 } 1573 // Conversions with Objective-C's id<...>. 1574 if ((FromObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || 1575 ToObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) && 1576 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType, 1577 /*compare=*/false)) { 1578 ConvertedType = ToType; 1579 return true; 1580 } 1581 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to an 1582 // interface to a pointer to a different interface. 1583 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToObjCPtr, FromObjCPtr)) { 1584 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = ToObjCPtr->getInterfaceType(); 1585 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = FromObjCPtr->getInterfaceType(); 1586 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && LHS && RHS && 1587 !ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs( 1588 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType())) 1589 return false; 1590 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr, 1591 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(), 1592 ToType, Context); 1593 return true; 1594 } 1595 1596 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr, ToObjCPtr)) { 1597 // Okay: this is some kind of implicit downcast of Objective-C 1598 // interfaces, which is permitted. However, we're going to 1599 // complain about it. 1600 IncompatibleObjC = true; 1601 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr, 1602 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(), 1603 ToType, Context); 1604 return true; 1605 } 1606 } 1607 // Beyond this point, both types need to be C pointers or block pointers. 1608 QualType ToPointeeType; 1609 if (const PointerType *ToCPtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) 1610 ToPointeeType = ToCPtr->getPointeeType(); 1611 else if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr = 1612 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) { 1613 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to any object 1614 // to a block pointer type. 1615 if (FromObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) { 1616 ConvertedType = ToType; 1617 return true; 1618 } 1619 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType(); 1620 } 1621 else if (FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() && 1622 ToObjCPtr && ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) { 1623 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a block pointer type to a 1624 // pointer to any object. 1625 ConvertedType = ToType; 1626 return true; 1627 } 1628 else 1629 return false; 1630 1631 QualType FromPointeeType; 1632 if (const PointerType *FromCPtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) 1633 FromPointeeType = FromCPtr->getPointeeType(); 1634 else if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr = FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) 1635 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType(); 1636 else 1637 return false; 1638 1639 // If we have pointers to pointers, recursively check whether this 1640 // is an Objective-C conversion. 1641 if (FromPointeeType->isPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isPointerType() && 1642 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType, 1643 IncompatibleObjC)) { 1644 // We always complain about this conversion. 1645 IncompatibleObjC = true; 1646 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType); 1647 return true; 1648 } 1649 // Allow conversion of pointee being objective-c pointer to another one; 1650 // as in I* to id. 1651 if (FromPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() && 1652 ToPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() && 1653 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType, 1654 IncompatibleObjC)) { 1655 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType); 1656 return true; 1657 } 1658 1659 // If we have pointers to functions or blocks, check whether the only 1660 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C 1661 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion (but 1662 // complain about it). 1663 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType 1664 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 1665 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType 1666 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 1667 if (FromFunctionType && ToFunctionType) { 1668 // If the function types are exactly the same, this isn't an 1669 // Objective-C pointer conversion. 1670 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromPointeeType) 1671 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointeeType)) 1672 return false; 1673 1674 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these 1675 // function types are obviously different. 1676 if (FromFunctionType->getNumArgs() != ToFunctionType->getNumArgs() || 1677 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic() || 1678 FromFunctionType->getTypeQuals() != ToFunctionType->getTypeQuals()) 1679 return false; 1680 1681 bool HasObjCConversion = false; 1682 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromFunctionType->getResultType()) 1683 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToFunctionType->getResultType())) { 1684 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do. 1685 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromFunctionType->getResultType(), 1686 ToFunctionType->getResultType(), 1687 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 1688 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion. 1689 HasObjCConversion = true; 1690 } else { 1691 // Function types are too different. Abort. 1692 return false; 1693 } 1694 1695 // Check argument types. 1696 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumArgs(); 1697 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 1698 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx); 1699 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx); 1700 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromArgType) 1701 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToArgType)) { 1702 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do. 1703 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromArgType, ToArgType, 1704 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 1705 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion. 1706 HasObjCConversion = true; 1707 } else { 1708 // Argument types are too different. Abort. 1709 return false; 1710 } 1711 } 1712 1713 if (HasObjCConversion) { 1714 // We had an Objective-C conversion. Allow this pointer 1715 // conversion, but complain about it. 1716 ConvertedType = ToType; 1717 IncompatibleObjC = true; 1718 return true; 1719 } 1720 } 1721 1722 return false; 1723} 1724 1725/// FunctionArgTypesAreEqual - This routine checks two function proto types 1726/// for equlity of their argument types. Caller has already checked that 1727/// they have same number of arguments. This routine assumes that Objective-C 1728/// pointer types which only differ in their protocol qualifiers are equal. 1729bool Sema::FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(FunctionProtoType* OldType, 1730 FunctionProtoType* NewType){ 1731 if (!getLangOptions().ObjC1) 1732 return std::equal(OldType->arg_type_begin(), OldType->arg_type_end(), 1733 NewType->arg_type_begin()); 1734 1735 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator O = OldType->arg_type_begin(), 1736 N = NewType->arg_type_begin(), 1737 E = OldType->arg_type_end(); O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) { 1738 QualType ToType = (*O); 1739 QualType FromType = (*N); 1740 if (ToType != FromType) { 1741 if (const PointerType *PTTo = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 1742 if (const PointerType *PTFr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) 1743 if ((PTTo->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && 1744 PTFr->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) || 1745 (PTTo->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && 1746 PTFr->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedClassType())) 1747 continue; 1748 } 1749 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTTo = 1750 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 1751 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTFr = 1752 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) 1753 if (PTTo->getInterfaceDecl() == PTFr->getInterfaceDecl()) 1754 continue; 1755 } 1756 return false; 1757 } 1758 } 1759 return true; 1760} 1761 1762/// CheckPointerConversion - Check the pointer conversion from the 1763/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for 1764/// ambiguous or inaccessible derived-to-base pointer 1765/// conversions for which IsPointerConversion has already returned 1766/// true. It returns true and produces a diagnostic if there was an 1767/// error, or returns false otherwise. 1768bool Sema::CheckPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1769 CastKind &Kind, 1770 CXXCastPath& BasePath, 1771 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) { 1772 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 1773 bool IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast = IgnoreBaseAccess; 1774 1775 Kind = CK_BitCast; 1776 1777 if (CXXBoolLiteralExpr* LitBool 1778 = dyn_cast<CXXBoolLiteralExpr>(From->IgnoreParens())) 1779 if (!IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast && LitBool->getValue() == false) 1780 Diag(LitBool->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_init_pointer_from_false) 1781 << ToType; 1782 1783 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) 1784 if (const PointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 1785 QualType FromPointeeType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(), 1786 ToPointeeType = ToPtrType->getPointeeType(); 1787 1788 if (FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() && 1789 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) { 1790 // We must have a derived-to-base conversion. Check an 1791 // ambiguous or inaccessible conversion. 1792 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, 1793 From->getExprLoc(), 1794 From->getSourceRange(), &BasePath, 1795 IgnoreBaseAccess)) 1796 return true; 1797 1798 // The conversion was successful. 1799 Kind = CK_DerivedToBase; 1800 } 1801 } 1802 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrType = 1803 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 1804 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrType = 1805 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 1806 // Objective-C++ conversions are always okay. 1807 // FIXME: We should have a different class of conversions for the 1808 // Objective-C++ implicit conversions. 1809 if (FromPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType() || ToPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType()) 1810 return false; 1811 } 1812 } 1813 1814 // We shouldn't fall into this case unless it's valid for other 1815 // reasons. 1816 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) 1817 Kind = CK_NullToPointer; 1818 1819 return false; 1820} 1821 1822/// IsMemberPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the 1823/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, can be 1824/// converted to the type ToType via a member pointer conversion (C++ 4.11). 1825/// If so, returns true and places the converted type (that might differ from 1826/// ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into ConvertedType. 1827bool Sema::IsMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, 1828 QualType ToType, 1829 bool InOverloadResolution, 1830 QualType &ConvertedType) { 1831 const MemberPointerType *ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 1832 if (!ToTypePtr) 1833 return false; 1834 1835 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a member pointer (C++ 4.11p1) 1836 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 1837 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull 1838 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) { 1839 ConvertedType = ToType; 1840 return true; 1841 } 1842 1843 // Otherwise, both types have to be member pointers. 1844 const MemberPointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 1845 if (!FromTypePtr) 1846 return false; 1847 1848 // A pointer to member of B can be converted to a pointer to member of D, 1849 // where D is derived from B (C++ 4.11p2). 1850 QualType FromClass(FromTypePtr->getClass(), 0); 1851 QualType ToClass(ToTypePtr->getClass(), 0); 1852 // FIXME: What happens when these are dependent? Is this function even called? 1853 1854 if (IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass)) { 1855 ConvertedType = Context.getMemberPointerType(FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(), 1856 ToClass.getTypePtr()); 1857 return true; 1858 } 1859 1860 return false; 1861} 1862 1863/// CheckMemberPointerConversion - Check the member pointer conversion from the 1864/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for ambiguous or 1865/// virtual or inaccessible base-to-derived member pointer conversions 1866/// for which IsMemberPointerConversion has already returned true. It returns 1867/// true and produces a diagnostic if there was an error, or returns false 1868/// otherwise. 1869bool Sema::CheckMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1870 CastKind &Kind, 1871 CXXCastPath &BasePath, 1872 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) { 1873 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 1874 const MemberPointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 1875 if (!FromPtrType) { 1876 // This must be a null pointer to member pointer conversion 1877 assert(From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 1878 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull) && 1879 "Expr must be null pointer constant!"); 1880 Kind = CK_NullToMemberPointer; 1881 return false; 1882 } 1883 1884 const MemberPointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 1885 assert(ToPtrType && "No member pointer cast has a target type " 1886 "that is not a member pointer."); 1887 1888 QualType FromClass = QualType(FromPtrType->getClass(), 0); 1889 QualType ToClass = QualType(ToPtrType->getClass(), 0); 1890 1891 // FIXME: What about dependent types? 1892 assert(FromClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class."); 1893 assert(ToClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class."); 1894 1895 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true, 1896 /*DetectVirtual=*/true); 1897 bool DerivationOkay = IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass, Paths); 1898 assert(DerivationOkay && 1899 "Should not have been called if derivation isn't OK."); 1900 (void)DerivationOkay; 1901 1902 if (Paths.isAmbiguous(Context.getCanonicalType(FromClass). 1903 getUnqualifiedType())) { 1904 std::string PathDisplayStr = getAmbiguousPathsDisplayString(Paths); 1905 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_ambiguous_memptr_conv) 1906 << 0 << FromClass << ToClass << PathDisplayStr << From->getSourceRange(); 1907 return true; 1908 } 1909 1910 if (const RecordType *VBase = Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) { 1911 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_memptr_conv_via_virtual) 1912 << FromClass << ToClass << QualType(VBase, 0) 1913 << From->getSourceRange(); 1914 return true; 1915 } 1916 1917 if (!IgnoreBaseAccess) 1918 CheckBaseClassAccess(From->getExprLoc(), FromClass, ToClass, 1919 Paths.front(), 1920 diag::err_downcast_from_inaccessible_base); 1921 1922 // Must be a base to derived member conversion. 1923 BuildBasePathArray(Paths, BasePath); 1924 Kind = CK_BaseToDerivedMemberPointer; 1925 return false; 1926} 1927 1928/// IsQualificationConversion - Determines whether the conversion from 1929/// an rvalue of type FromType to ToType is a qualification conversion 1930/// (C++ 4.4). 1931bool 1932Sema::IsQualificationConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) { 1933 FromType = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 1934 ToType = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType); 1935 1936 // If FromType and ToType are the same type, this is not a 1937 // qualification conversion. 1938 if (FromType.getUnqualifiedType() == ToType.getUnqualifiedType()) 1939 return false; 1940 1941 // (C++ 4.4p4): 1942 // A conversion can add cv-qualifiers at levels other than the first 1943 // in multi-level pointers, subject to the following rules: [...] 1944 bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true; 1945 bool UnwrappedAnyPointer = false; 1946 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(FromType, ToType)) { 1947 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to 1948 // determine if this still looks like a qualification 1949 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of 1950 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again 1951 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left to 1952 // unwrap. 1953 UnwrappedAnyPointer = true; 1954 1955 // -- for every j > 0, if const is in cv 1,j then const is in cv 1956 // 2,j, and similarly for volatile. 1957 if (!ToType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromType)) 1958 return false; 1959 1960 // -- if the cv 1,j and cv 2,j are different, then const is in 1961 // every cv for 0 < k < j. 1962 if (FromType.getCVRQualifiers() != ToType.getCVRQualifiers() 1963 && !PreviousToQualsIncludeConst) 1964 return false; 1965 1966 // Keep track of whether all prior cv-qualifiers in the "to" type 1967 // include const. 1968 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst 1969 = PreviousToQualsIncludeConst && ToType.isConstQualified(); 1970 } 1971 1972 // We are left with FromType and ToType being the pointee types 1973 // after unwrapping the original FromType and ToType the same number 1974 // of types. If we unwrapped any pointers, and if FromType and 1975 // ToType have the same unqualified type (since we checked 1976 // qualifiers above), then this is a qualification conversion. 1977 return UnwrappedAnyPointer && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType,ToType); 1978} 1979 1980/// Determines whether there is a user-defined conversion sequence 1981/// (C++ [over.ics.user]) that converts expression From to the type 1982/// ToType. If such a conversion exists, User will contain the 1983/// user-defined conversion sequence that performs such a conversion 1984/// and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this routine returns 1985/// false and User is unspecified. 1986/// 1987/// \param AllowExplicit true if the conversion should consider C++0x 1988/// "explicit" conversion functions as well as non-explicit conversion 1989/// functions (C++0x [class.conv.fct]p2). 1990static OverloadingResult 1991IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1992 UserDefinedConversionSequence& User, 1993 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 1994 bool AllowExplicit) { 1995 // Whether we will only visit constructors. 1996 bool ConstructorsOnly = false; 1997 1998 // If the type we are conversion to is a class type, enumerate its 1999 // constructors. 2000 if (const RecordType *ToRecordType = ToType->getAs<RecordType>()) { 2001 // C++ [over.match.ctor]p1: 2002 // When objects of class type are direct-initialized (8.5), or 2003 // copy-initialized from an expression of the same or a 2004 // derived class type (8.5), overload resolution selects the 2005 // constructor. [...] For copy-initialization, the candidate 2006 // functions are all the converting constructors (12.3.1) of 2007 // that class. The argument list is the expression-list within 2008 // the parentheses of the initializer. 2009 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, From->getType()) || 2010 (From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>() && 2011 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getType(), ToType))) 2012 ConstructorsOnly = true; 2013 2014 if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType, S.PDiag())) { 2015 // We're not going to find any constructors. 2016 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *ToRecordDecl 2017 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ToRecordType->getDecl())) { 2018 DeclContext::lookup_iterator Con, ConEnd; 2019 for (llvm::tie(Con, ConEnd) = S.LookupConstructors(ToRecordDecl); 2020 Con != ConEnd; ++Con) { 2021 NamedDecl *D = *Con; 2022 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(D, D->getAccess()); 2023 2024 // Find the constructor (which may be a template). 2025 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = 0; 2026 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConstructorTmpl 2027 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D); 2028 if (ConstructorTmpl) 2029 Constructor 2030 = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ConstructorTmpl->getTemplatedDecl()); 2031 else 2032 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D); 2033 2034 if (!Constructor->isInvalidDecl() && 2035 Constructor->isConvertingConstructor(AllowExplicit)) { 2036 if (ConstructorTmpl) 2037 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(ConstructorTmpl, FoundDecl, 2038 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0, 2039 &From, 1, CandidateSet, 2040 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/ 2041 !ConstructorsOnly); 2042 else 2043 // Allow one user-defined conversion when user specifies a 2044 // From->ToType conversion via an static cast (c-style, etc). 2045 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Constructor, FoundDecl, 2046 &From, 1, CandidateSet, 2047 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/ 2048 !ConstructorsOnly); 2049 } 2050 } 2051 } 2052 } 2053 2054 // Enumerate conversion functions, if we're allowed to. 2055 if (ConstructorsOnly) { 2056 } else if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), From->getType(), 2057 S.PDiag(0) << From->getSourceRange())) { 2058 // No conversion functions from incomplete types. 2059 } else if (const RecordType *FromRecordType 2060 = From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) { 2061 if (CXXRecordDecl *FromRecordDecl 2062 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FromRecordType->getDecl())) { 2063 // Add all of the conversion functions as candidates. 2064 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions 2065 = FromRecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 2066 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(), 2067 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) { 2068 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = I.getPair(); 2069 NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl(); 2070 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext()); 2071 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 2072 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 2073 2074 CXXConversionDecl *Conv; 2075 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate; 2076 if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))) 2077 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()); 2078 else 2079 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 2080 2081 if (AllowExplicit || !Conv->isExplicit()) { 2082 if (ConvTemplate) 2083 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, FoundDecl, 2084 ActingContext, From, ToType, 2085 CandidateSet); 2086 else 2087 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext, 2088 From, ToType, CandidateSet); 2089 } 2090 } 2091 } 2092 } 2093 2094 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 2095 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(), Best, true)) { 2096 case OR_Success: 2097 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function. 2098 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor 2099 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function)) { 2100 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1: 2101 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a 2102 // constructor (12.3.1), the initial standard conversion 2103 // sequence converts the source type to the type required by 2104 // the argument of the constructor. 2105 // 2106 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context); 2107 if (Best->Conversions[0].isEllipsis()) 2108 User.EllipsisConversion = true; 2109 else { 2110 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard; 2111 User.EllipsisConversion = false; 2112 } 2113 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor; 2114 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion(); 2115 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()); 2116 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType); 2117 return OR_Success; 2118 } else if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion 2119 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Best->Function)) { 2120 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1: 2121 // 2122 // [...] If the user-defined conversion is specified by a 2123 // conversion function (12.3.2), the initial standard 2124 // conversion sequence converts the source type to the 2125 // implicit object parameter of the conversion function. 2126 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard; 2127 User.ConversionFunction = Conversion; 2128 User.EllipsisConversion = false; 2129 2130 // C++ [over.ics.user]p2: 2131 // The second standard conversion sequence converts the 2132 // result of the user-defined conversion to the target type 2133 // for the sequence. Since an implicit conversion sequence 2134 // is an initialization, the special rules for 2135 // initialization by user-defined conversion apply when 2136 // selecting the best user-defined conversion for a 2137 // user-defined conversion sequence (see 13.3.3 and 2138 // 13.3.3.1). 2139 User.After = Best->FinalConversion; 2140 return OR_Success; 2141 } else { 2142 llvm_unreachable("Not a constructor or conversion function?"); 2143 return OR_No_Viable_Function; 2144 } 2145 2146 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 2147 return OR_No_Viable_Function; 2148 case OR_Deleted: 2149 // No conversion here! We're done. 2150 return OR_Deleted; 2151 2152 case OR_Ambiguous: 2153 return OR_Ambiguous; 2154 } 2155 2156 return OR_No_Viable_Function; 2157} 2158 2159bool 2160Sema::DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType) { 2161 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 2162 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(From->getExprLoc()); 2163 OverloadingResult OvResult = 2164 IsUserDefinedConversion(*this, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined, 2165 CandidateSet, false); 2166 if (OvResult == OR_Ambiguous) 2167 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(), 2168 diag::err_typecheck_ambiguous_condition) 2169 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange(); 2170 else if (OvResult == OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty()) 2171 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(), 2172 diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition) 2173 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange(); 2174 else 2175 return false; 2176 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, &From, 1); 2177 return true; 2178} 2179 2180/// CompareImplicitConversionSequences - Compare two implicit 2181/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the 2182/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2). 2183static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 2184CompareImplicitConversionSequences(Sema &S, 2185 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS1, 2186 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS2) 2187{ 2188 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p2): When comparing the basic forms of implicit 2189 // conversion sequences (as defined in 13.3.3.1) 2190 // -- a standard conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.1) is a better 2191 // conversion sequence than a user-defined conversion sequence or 2192 // an ellipsis conversion sequence, and 2193 // -- a user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2) is a better 2194 // conversion sequence than an ellipsis conversion sequence 2195 // (13.3.3.1.3). 2196 // 2197 // C++0x [over.best.ics]p10: 2198 // For the purpose of ranking implicit conversion sequences as 2199 // described in 13.3.3.2, the ambiguous conversion sequence is 2200 // treated as a user-defined sequence that is indistinguishable 2201 // from any other user-defined conversion sequence. 2202 if (ICS1.getKindRank() < ICS2.getKindRank()) 2203 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 2204 else if (ICS2.getKindRank() < ICS1.getKindRank()) 2205 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 2206 2207 // The following checks require both conversion sequences to be of 2208 // the same kind. 2209 if (ICS1.getKind() != ICS2.getKind()) 2210 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 2211 2212 // Two implicit conversion sequences of the same form are 2213 // indistinguishable conversion sequences unless one of the 2214 // following rules apply: (C++ 13.3.3.2p3): 2215 if (ICS1.isStandard()) 2216 return CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, ICS1.Standard, ICS2.Standard); 2217 else if (ICS1.isUserDefined()) { 2218 // User-defined conversion sequence U1 is a better conversion 2219 // sequence than another user-defined conversion sequence U2 if 2220 // they contain the same user-defined conversion function or 2221 // constructor and if the second standard conversion sequence of 2222 // U1 is better than the second standard conversion sequence of 2223 // U2 (C++ 13.3.3.2p3). 2224 if (ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction == 2225 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction) 2226 return CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, 2227 ICS1.UserDefined.After, 2228 ICS2.UserDefined.After); 2229 } 2230 2231 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 2232} 2233 2234static bool hasSimilarType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T1, QualType T2) { 2235 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) { 2236 Qualifiers Quals; 2237 T1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, Quals); 2238 T2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, Quals); 2239 } 2240 2241 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2); 2242} 2243 2244// Per 13.3.3.2p3, compare the given standard conversion sequences to 2245// determine if one is a proper subset of the other. 2246static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 2247compareStandardConversionSubsets(ASTContext &Context, 2248 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 2249 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) { 2250 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result 2251 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 2252 2253 // the identity conversion sequence is considered to be a subsequence of 2254 // any non-identity conversion sequence 2255 if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding == SCS2.ReferenceBinding) { 2256 if (SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && !SCS2.isIdentityConversion()) 2257 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 2258 else if (!SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && SCS2.isIdentityConversion()) 2259 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 2260 } 2261 2262 if (SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second) { 2263 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Identity) 2264 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 2265 else if (SCS2.Second == ICK_Identity) 2266 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 2267 else 2268 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 2269 } else if (!hasSimilarType(Context, SCS1.getToType(1), SCS2.getToType(1))) 2270 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 2271 2272 if (SCS1.Third == SCS2.Third) { 2273 return Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getToType(2), SCS2.getToType(2))? Result 2274 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 2275 } 2276 2277 if (SCS1.Third == ICK_Identity) 2278 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 2279 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable 2280 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 2281 2282 if (SCS2.Third == ICK_Identity) 2283 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 2284 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable 2285 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 2286 2287 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 2288} 2289 2290/// CompareStandardConversionSequences - Compare two standard 2291/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the 2292/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2p3). 2293static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 2294CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S, 2295 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 2296 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) 2297{ 2298 // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence 2299 // than standard conversion sequence S2 if (C++ 13.3.3.2p3): 2300 2301 // -- S1 is a proper subsequence of S2 (comparing the conversion 2302 // sequences in the canonical form defined by 13.3.3.1.1, 2303 // excluding any Lvalue Transformation; the identity conversion 2304 // sequence is considered to be a subsequence of any 2305 // non-identity conversion sequence) or, if not that, 2306 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind CK 2307 = compareStandardConversionSubsets(S.Context, SCS1, SCS2)) 2308 return CK; 2309 2310 // -- the rank of S1 is better than the rank of S2 (by the rules 2311 // defined below), or, if not that, 2312 ImplicitConversionRank Rank1 = SCS1.getRank(); 2313 ImplicitConversionRank Rank2 = SCS2.getRank(); 2314 if (Rank1 < Rank2) 2315 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 2316 else if (Rank2 < Rank1) 2317 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 2318 2319 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p4): Two conversion sequences with the same rank 2320 // are indistinguishable unless one of the following rules 2321 // applies: 2322 2323 // A conversion that is not a conversion of a pointer, or 2324 // pointer to member, to bool is better than another conversion 2325 // that is such a conversion. 2326 if (SCS1.isPointerConversionToBool() != SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool()) 2327 return SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool() 2328 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 2329 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 2330 2331 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b2: 2332 // 2333 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A, 2334 // conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of B* to 2335 // void*, and conversion of A* to void* is better than conversion 2336 // of B* to void*. 2337 bool SCS1ConvertsToVoid 2338 = SCS1.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context); 2339 bool SCS2ConvertsToVoid 2340 = SCS2.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context); 2341 if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid != SCS2ConvertsToVoid) { 2342 // Exactly one of the conversion sequences is a conversion to 2343 // a void pointer; it's the worse conversion. 2344 return SCS2ConvertsToVoid ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 2345 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 2346 } else if (!SCS1ConvertsToVoid && !SCS2ConvertsToVoid) { 2347 // Neither conversion sequence converts to a void pointer; compare 2348 // their derived-to-base conversions. 2349 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind DerivedCK 2350 = CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2)) 2351 return DerivedCK; 2352 } else if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid && SCS2ConvertsToVoid) { 2353 // Both conversion sequences are conversions to void 2354 // pointers. Compare the source types to determine if there's an 2355 // inheritance relationship in their sources. 2356 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType(); 2357 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType(); 2358 2359 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer 2360 // conversion, if we need to. 2361 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 2362 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1); 2363 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 2364 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2); 2365 2366 QualType FromPointee1 2367 = FromType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 2368 QualType FromPointee2 2369 = FromType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 2370 2371 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1)) 2372 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 2373 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2)) 2374 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 2375 2376 // Objective-C++: If one interface is more specific than the 2377 // other, it is the better one. 2378 const ObjCObjectType* FromIface1 = FromPointee1->getAs<ObjCObjectType>(); 2379 const ObjCObjectType* FromIface2 = FromPointee2->getAs<ObjCObjectType>(); 2380 if (FromIface1 && FromIface1) { 2381 if (S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromIface2, FromIface1)) 2382 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 2383 else if (S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromIface1, FromIface2)) 2384 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 2385 } 2386 } 2387 2388 // Compare based on qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3, 2389 // bullet 3). 2390 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind QualCK 2391 = CompareQualificationConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2)) 2392 return QualCK; 2393 2394 if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) { 2395 // C++0x [over.ics.rank]p3b4: 2396 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3) and neither refers to an 2397 // implicit object parameter of a non-static member function declared 2398 // without a ref-qualifier, and S1 binds an rvalue reference to an 2399 // rvalue and S2 binds an lvalue reference. 2400 // FIXME: We don't know if we're dealing with the implicit object parameter, 2401 // or if the member function in this case has a ref qualifier. 2402 // (Of course, we don't have ref qualifiers yet.) 2403 if (SCS1.RRefBinding != SCS2.RRefBinding) 2404 return SCS1.RRefBinding ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 2405 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 2406 2407 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p3b4: 2408 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3), and the types to 2409 // which the references refer are the same type except for 2410 // top-level cv-qualifiers, and the type to which the reference 2411 // initialized by S2 refers is more cv-qualified than the type 2412 // to which the reference initialized by S1 refers. 2413 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2); 2414 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2); 2415 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1); 2416 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2); 2417 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals; 2418 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals); 2419 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals); 2420 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) { 2421 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type 2422 // for comparison. 2423 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals) 2424 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals); 2425 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals) 2426 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals); 2427 if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) 2428 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 2429 else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) 2430 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 2431 } 2432 } 2433 2434 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 2435} 2436 2437/// CompareQualificationConversions - Compares two standard conversion 2438/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their 2439/// qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3 bullet 3). 2440ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 2441CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S, 2442 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 2443 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) { 2444 // C++ 13.3.3.2p3: 2445 // -- S1 and S2 differ only in their qualification conversion and 2446 // yield similar types T1 and T2 (C++ 4.4), respectively, and the 2447 // cv-qualification signature of type T1 is a proper subset of 2448 // the cv-qualification signature of type T2, and S1 is not the 2449 // deprecated string literal array-to-pointer conversion (4.2). 2450 if (SCS1.First != SCS2.First || SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second || 2451 SCS1.Third != SCS2.Third || SCS1.Third != ICK_Qualification) 2452 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 2453 2454 // FIXME: the example in the standard doesn't use a qualification 2455 // conversion (!) 2456 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2); 2457 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2); 2458 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1); 2459 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2); 2460 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals; 2461 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals); 2462 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals); 2463 2464 // If the types are the same, we won't learn anything by unwrapped 2465 // them. 2466 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) 2467 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 2468 2469 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type 2470 // for comparison. 2471 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals) 2472 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals); 2473 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals) 2474 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals); 2475 2476 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result 2477 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 2478 while (S.Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) { 2479 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to 2480 // determine if this still looks like a qualification 2481 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of 2482 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again 2483 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left 2484 // to unwrap. This essentially mimics what 2485 // IsQualificationConversion does, but here we're checking for a 2486 // strict subset of qualifiers. 2487 if (T1.getCVRQualifiers() == T2.getCVRQualifiers()) 2488 // The qualifiers are the same, so this doesn't tell us anything 2489 // about how the sequences rank. 2490 ; 2491 else if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) { 2492 // T1 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence. 2493 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse) 2494 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's 2495 // qualifiers. 2496 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 2497 2498 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 2499 } else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) { 2500 // T2 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence. 2501 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better) 2502 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's 2503 // qualifiers. 2504 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 2505 2506 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 2507 } else { 2508 // Qualifiers are disjoint. 2509 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 2510 } 2511 2512 // If the types after this point are equivalent, we're done. 2513 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2)) 2514 break; 2515 } 2516 2517 // Check that the winning standard conversion sequence isn't using 2518 // the deprecated string literal array to pointer conversion. 2519 switch (Result) { 2520 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better: 2521 if (SCS1.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr) 2522 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 2523 break; 2524 2525 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable: 2526 break; 2527 2528 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse: 2529 if (SCS2.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr) 2530 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 2531 break; 2532 } 2533 2534 return Result; 2535} 2536 2537/// CompareDerivedToBaseConversions - Compares two standard conversion 2538/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their 2539/// various kinds of derived-to-base conversions (C++ 2540/// [over.ics.rank]p4b3). As part of these checks, we also look at 2541/// conversions between Objective-C interface types. 2542ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 2543CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S, 2544 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 2545 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) { 2546 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType(); 2547 QualType ToType1 = SCS1.getToType(1); 2548 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType(); 2549 QualType ToType2 = SCS2.getToType(1); 2550 2551 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer 2552 // conversion, if we need to. 2553 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 2554 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1); 2555 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 2556 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2); 2557 2558 // Canonicalize all of the types. 2559 FromType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType1); 2560 ToType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType1); 2561 FromType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType2); 2562 ToType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType2); 2563 2564 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b3: 2565 // 2566 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A and 2567 // class C is derived directly or indirectly from B, 2568 // 2569 // For Objective-C, we let A, B, and C also be Objective-C 2570 // interfaces. 2571 2572 // Compare based on pointer conversions. 2573 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && 2574 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && 2575 /*FIXME: Remove if Objective-C id conversions get their own rank*/ 2576 FromType1->isPointerType() && FromType2->isPointerType() && 2577 ToType1->isPointerType() && ToType2->isPointerType()) { 2578 QualType FromPointee1 2579 = FromType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 2580 QualType ToPointee1 2581 = ToType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 2582 QualType FromPointee2 2583 = FromType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 2584 QualType ToPointee2 2585 = ToType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 2586 2587 const ObjCObjectType* FromIface1 = FromPointee1->getAs<ObjCObjectType>(); 2588 const ObjCObjectType* FromIface2 = FromPointee2->getAs<ObjCObjectType>(); 2589 const ObjCObjectType* ToIface1 = ToPointee1->getAs<ObjCObjectType>(); 2590 const ObjCObjectType* ToIface2 = ToPointee2->getAs<ObjCObjectType>(); 2591 2592 // -- conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*, 2593 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) { 2594 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2)) 2595 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 2596 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1)) 2597 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 2598 2599 if (ToIface1 && ToIface2) { 2600 if (S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToIface2, ToIface1)) 2601 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 2602 else if (S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToIface1, ToIface2)) 2603 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 2604 } 2605 } 2606 2607 // -- conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*, 2608 if (FromPointee1 != FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 == ToPointee2) { 2609 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1)) 2610 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 2611 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2)) 2612 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 2613 2614 if (FromIface1 && FromIface2) { 2615 if (S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromIface1, FromIface2)) 2616 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 2617 else if (S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromIface2, FromIface1)) 2618 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 2619 } 2620 } 2621 } 2622 2623 // Ranking of member-pointer types. 2624 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && 2625 FromType1->isMemberPointerType() && FromType2->isMemberPointerType() && 2626 ToType1->isMemberPointerType() && ToType2->isMemberPointerType()) { 2627 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer1 = 2628 FromType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 2629 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer1 = 2630 ToType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 2631 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer2 = 2632 FromType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 2633 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer2 = 2634 ToType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 2635 const Type *FromPointeeType1 = FromMemPointer1->getClass(); 2636 const Type *ToPointeeType1 = ToMemPointer1->getClass(); 2637 const Type *FromPointeeType2 = FromMemPointer2->getClass(); 2638 const Type *ToPointeeType2 = ToMemPointer2->getClass(); 2639 QualType FromPointee1 = QualType(FromPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType(); 2640 QualType ToPointee1 = QualType(ToPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType(); 2641 QualType FromPointee2 = QualType(FromPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType(); 2642 QualType ToPointee2 = QualType(ToPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType(); 2643 // conversion of A::* to B::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*, 2644 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) { 2645 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2)) 2646 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 2647 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1)) 2648 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 2649 } 2650 // conversion of B::* to C::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::* 2651 if (ToPointee1 == ToPointee2 && FromPointee1 != FromPointee2) { 2652 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2)) 2653 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 2654 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1)) 2655 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 2656 } 2657 } 2658 2659 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) { 2660 // -- conversion of C to B is better than conversion of C to A, 2661 // -- binding of an expression of type C to a reference of type 2662 // B& is better than binding an expression of type C to a 2663 // reference of type A&, 2664 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) && 2665 !S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) { 2666 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType1, ToType2)) 2667 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 2668 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType2, ToType1)) 2669 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 2670 } 2671 2672 // -- conversion of B to A is better than conversion of C to A. 2673 // -- binding of an expression of type B to a reference of type 2674 // A& is better than binding an expression of type C to a 2675 // reference of type A&, 2676 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) && 2677 S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) { 2678 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType2, FromType1)) 2679 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 2680 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType1, FromType2)) 2681 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 2682 } 2683 } 2684 2685 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 2686} 2687 2688/// CompareReferenceRelationship - Compare the two types T1 and T2 to 2689/// determine whether they are reference-related, 2690/// reference-compatible, reference-compatible with added 2691/// qualification, or incompatible, for use in C++ initialization by 2692/// reference (C++ [dcl.ref.init]p4). Neither type can be a reference 2693/// type, and the first type (T1) is the pointee type of the reference 2694/// type being initialized. 2695Sema::ReferenceCompareResult 2696Sema::CompareReferenceRelationship(SourceLocation Loc, 2697 QualType OrigT1, QualType OrigT2, 2698 bool &DerivedToBase, 2699 bool &ObjCConversion) { 2700 assert(!OrigT1->isReferenceType() && 2701 "T1 must be the pointee type of the reference type"); 2702 assert(!OrigT2->isReferenceType() && "T2 cannot be a reference type"); 2703 2704 QualType T1 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT1); 2705 QualType T2 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT2); 2706 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals; 2707 QualType UnqualT1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals); 2708 QualType UnqualT2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals); 2709 2710 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4: 2711 // Given types "cv1 T1" and "cv2 T2," "cv1 T1" is 2712 // reference-related to "cv2 T2" if T1 is the same type as T2, or 2713 // T1 is a base class of T2. 2714 DerivedToBase = false; 2715 ObjCConversion = false; 2716 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) { 2717 // Nothing to do. 2718 } else if (!RequireCompleteType(Loc, OrigT2, PDiag()) && 2719 IsDerivedFrom(UnqualT2, UnqualT1)) 2720 DerivedToBase = true; 2721 else if (UnqualT1->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() && 2722 UnqualT2->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() && 2723 Context.canBindObjCObjectType(UnqualT1, UnqualT2)) 2724 ObjCConversion = true; 2725 else 2726 return Ref_Incompatible; 2727 2728 // At this point, we know that T1 and T2 are reference-related (at 2729 // least). 2730 2731 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type 2732 // for comparison. 2733 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals) 2734 T1 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals); 2735 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals) 2736 T2 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals); 2737 2738 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4: 2739 // "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2" if T1 is 2740 // reference-related to T2 and cv1 is the same cv-qualification 2741 // as, or greater cv-qualification than, cv2. For purposes of 2742 // overload resolution, cases for which cv1 is greater 2743 // cv-qualification than cv2 are identified as 2744 // reference-compatible with added qualification (see 13.3.3.2). 2745 if (T1Quals.getCVRQualifiers() == T2Quals.getCVRQualifiers()) 2746 return Ref_Compatible; 2747 else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) 2748 return Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification; 2749 else 2750 return Ref_Related; 2751} 2752 2753/// \brief Look for a user-defined conversion to an value reference-compatible 2754/// with DeclType. Return true if something definite is found. 2755static bool 2756FindConversionForRefInit(Sema &S, ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS, 2757 QualType DeclType, SourceLocation DeclLoc, 2758 Expr *Init, QualType T2, bool AllowRvalues, 2759 bool AllowExplicit) { 2760 assert(T2->isRecordType() && "Can only find conversions of record types."); 2761 CXXRecordDecl *T2RecordDecl 2762 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(T2->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()); 2763 2764 QualType ToType 2765 = AllowRvalues? DeclType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType() 2766 : DeclType; 2767 2768 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(DeclLoc); 2769 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions 2770 = T2RecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 2771 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(), 2772 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) { 2773 NamedDecl *D = *I; 2774 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext()); 2775 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 2776 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 2777 2778 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate 2779 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D); 2780 CXXConversionDecl *Conv; 2781 if (ConvTemplate) 2782 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()); 2783 else 2784 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 2785 2786 // If this is an explicit conversion, and we're not allowed to consider 2787 // explicit conversions, skip it. 2788 if (!AllowExplicit && Conv->isExplicit()) 2789 continue; 2790 2791 if (AllowRvalues) { 2792 bool DerivedToBase = false; 2793 bool ObjCConversion = false; 2794 if (!ConvTemplate && 2795 S.CompareReferenceRelationship(DeclLoc, 2796 Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType().getUnqualifiedType(), 2797 DeclType.getNonReferenceType().getUnqualifiedType(), 2798 DerivedToBase, ObjCConversion) 2799 == Sema::Ref_Incompatible) 2800 continue; 2801 } else { 2802 // If the conversion function doesn't return a reference type, 2803 // it can't be considered for this conversion. An rvalue reference 2804 // is only acceptable if its referencee is a function type. 2805 2806 const ReferenceType *RefType = 2807 Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<ReferenceType>(); 2808 if (!RefType || 2809 (!RefType->isLValueReferenceType() && 2810 !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType())) 2811 continue; 2812 } 2813 2814 if (ConvTemplate) 2815 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, I.getPair(), ActingDC, 2816 Init, ToType, CandidateSet); 2817 else 2818 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init, 2819 ToType, CandidateSet); 2820 } 2821 2822 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 2823 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, DeclLoc, Best, true)) { 2824 case OR_Success: 2825 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1: 2826 // 2827 // [...] If the parameter binds directly to the result of 2828 // applying a conversion function to the argument 2829 // expression, the implicit conversion sequence is a 2830 // user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2), with the 2831 // second standard conversion sequence either an identity 2832 // conversion or, if the conversion function returns an 2833 // entity of a type that is a derived class of the parameter 2834 // type, a derived-to-base Conversion. 2835 if (!Best->FinalConversion.DirectBinding) 2836 return false; 2837 2838 ICS.setUserDefined(); 2839 ICS.UserDefined.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard; 2840 ICS.UserDefined.After = Best->FinalConversion; 2841 ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Best->Function; 2842 ICS.UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false; 2843 assert(ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding && 2844 ICS.UserDefined.After.DirectBinding && 2845 "Expected a direct reference binding!"); 2846 return true; 2847 2848 case OR_Ambiguous: 2849 ICS.setAmbiguous(); 2850 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(); 2851 Cand != CandidateSet.end(); ++Cand) 2852 if (Cand->Viable) 2853 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function); 2854 return true; 2855 2856 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 2857 case OR_Deleted: 2858 // There was no suitable conversion, or we found a deleted 2859 // conversion; continue with other checks. 2860 return false; 2861 } 2862 2863 return false; 2864} 2865 2866/// \brief Compute an implicit conversion sequence for reference 2867/// initialization. 2868static ImplicitConversionSequence 2869TryReferenceInit(Sema &S, Expr *&Init, QualType DeclType, 2870 SourceLocation DeclLoc, 2871 bool SuppressUserConversions, 2872 bool AllowExplicit) { 2873 assert(DeclType->isReferenceType() && "Reference init needs a reference"); 2874 2875 // Most paths end in a failed conversion. 2876 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 2877 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType); 2878 2879 QualType T1 = DeclType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType(); 2880 QualType T2 = Init->getType(); 2881 2882 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try 2883 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the 2884 // type of the resulting function. 2885 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) { 2886 DeclAccessPair Found; 2887 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Init, DeclType, 2888 false, Found)) 2889 T2 = Fn->getType(); 2890 } 2891 2892 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer. 2893 bool isRValRef = DeclType->isRValueReferenceType(); 2894 bool DerivedToBase = false; 2895 bool ObjCConversion = false; 2896 Expr::Classification InitCategory = Init->Classify(S.Context); 2897 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship 2898 = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(DeclLoc, T1, T2, DerivedToBase, 2899 ObjCConversion); 2900 2901 2902 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5: 2903 // A reference to type "cv1 T1" is initialized by an expression 2904 // of type "cv2 T2" as follows: 2905 2906 // -- If reference is an lvalue reference and the initializer expression 2907 // The next bullet point (T1 is a function) is pretty much equivalent to this 2908 // one, so it's handled here. 2909 if (!isRValRef || T1->isFunctionType()) { 2910 // -- is an lvalue (but is not a bit-field), and "cv1 T1" is 2911 // reference-compatible with "cv2 T2," or 2912 // 2913 // Per C++ [over.ics.ref]p4, we don't check the bit-field property here. 2914 if (InitCategory.isLValue() && 2915 RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification) { 2916 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1: 2917 // When a parameter of reference type binds directly (8.5.3) 2918 // to an argument expression, the implicit conversion sequence 2919 // is the identity conversion, unless the argument expression 2920 // has a type that is a derived class of the parameter type, 2921 // in which case the implicit conversion sequence is a 2922 // derived-to-base Conversion (13.3.3.1). 2923 ICS.setStandard(); 2924 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity; 2925 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base 2926 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion 2927 : ICK_Identity; 2928 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity; 2929 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr(); 2930 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2); 2931 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1); 2932 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1); 2933 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true; 2934 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true; 2935 ICS.Standard.RRefBinding = isRValRef; 2936 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0; 2937 2938 // Nothing more to do: the inaccessibility/ambiguity check for 2939 // derived-to-base conversions is suppressed when we're 2940 // computing the implicit conversion sequence (C++ 2941 // [over.best.ics]p2). 2942 return ICS; 2943 } 2944 2945 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is 2946 // not reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly 2947 // converted to an lvalue of type "cv3 T3," where "cv1 T1" 2948 // is reference-compatible with "cv3 T3" 92) (this 2949 // conversion is selected by enumerating the applicable 2950 // conversion functions (13.3.1.6) and choosing the best 2951 // one through overload resolution (13.3)), 2952 if (!SuppressUserConversions && T2->isRecordType() && 2953 !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) && 2954 RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible) { 2955 if (FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc, 2956 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/false, 2957 AllowExplicit)) 2958 return ICS; 2959 } 2960 } 2961 2962 // -- Otherwise, the reference shall be an lvalue reference to a 2963 // non-volatile const type (i.e., cv1 shall be const), or the reference 2964 // shall be an rvalue reference and the initializer expression shall be 2965 // an rvalue or have a function type. 2966 // 2967 // We actually handle one oddity of C++ [over.ics.ref] at this 2968 // point, which is that, due to p2 (which short-circuits reference 2969 // binding by only attempting a simple conversion for non-direct 2970 // bindings) and p3's strange wording, we allow a const volatile 2971 // reference to bind to an rvalue. Hence the check for the presence 2972 // of "const" rather than checking for "const" being the only 2973 // qualifier. 2974 // This is also the point where rvalue references and lvalue inits no longer 2975 // go together. 2976 if ((!isRValRef && !T1.isConstQualified()) || 2977 (isRValRef && InitCategory.isLValue())) 2978 return ICS; 2979 2980 // -- If T1 is a function type, then 2981 // -- if T2 is the same type as T1, the reference is bound to the 2982 // initializer expression lvalue; 2983 // -- if T2 is a class type and the initializer expression can be 2984 // implicitly converted to an lvalue of type T1 [...], the 2985 // reference is bound to the function lvalue that is the result 2986 // of the conversion; 2987 // This is the same as for the lvalue case above, so it was handled there. 2988 // -- otherwise, the program is ill-formed. 2989 // This is the one difference to the lvalue case. 2990 if (T1->isFunctionType()) 2991 return ICS; 2992 2993 // -- Otherwise, if T2 is a class type and 2994 // -- the initializer expression is an rvalue and "cv1 T1" 2995 // is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2," or 2996 // 2997 // -- T1 is not reference-related to T2 and the initializer 2998 // expression can be implicitly converted to an rvalue 2999 // of type "cv3 T3" (this conversion is selected by 3000 // enumerating the applicable conversion functions 3001 // (13.3.1.6) and choosing the best one through overload 3002 // resolution (13.3)), 3003 // 3004 // then the reference is bound to the initializer 3005 // expression rvalue in the first case and to the object 3006 // that is the result of the conversion in the second case 3007 // (or, in either case, to the appropriate base class 3008 // subobject of the object). 3009 if (T2->isRecordType()) { 3010 // First case: "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2". This is a 3011 // direct binding in C++0x but not in C++03. 3012 if (InitCategory.isRValue() && 3013 RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification) { 3014 ICS.setStandard(); 3015 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity; 3016 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base 3017 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion 3018 : ICK_Identity; 3019 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity; 3020 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr(); 3021 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2); 3022 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1); 3023 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1); 3024 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true; 3025 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x; 3026 ICS.Standard.RRefBinding = isRValRef; 3027 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0; 3028 return ICS; 3029 } 3030 3031 // Second case: not reference-related. 3032 if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible && 3033 !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) && 3034 FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc, 3035 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/true, 3036 AllowExplicit)) 3037 return ICS; 3038 } 3039 3040 // -- Otherwise, a temporary of type "cv1 T1" is created and 3041 // initialized from the initializer expression using the 3042 // rules for a non-reference copy initialization (8.5). The 3043 // reference is then bound to the temporary. If T1 is 3044 // reference-related to T2, cv1 must be the same 3045 // cv-qualification as, or greater cv-qualification than, 3046 // cv2; otherwise, the program is ill-formed. 3047 if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Related) { 3048 // If cv1 == cv2 or cv1 is a greater cv-qualified than cv2, then 3049 // we would be reference-compatible or reference-compatible with 3050 // added qualification. But that wasn't the case, so the reference 3051 // initialization fails. 3052 return ICS; 3053 } 3054 3055 // If at least one of the types is a class type, the types are not 3056 // related, and we aren't allowed any user conversions, the 3057 // reference binding fails. This case is important for breaking 3058 // recursion, since TryImplicitConversion below will attempt to 3059 // create a temporary through the use of a copy constructor. 3060 if (SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible && 3061 (T1->isRecordType() || T2->isRecordType())) 3062 return ICS; 3063 3064 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p2: 3065 // When a parameter of reference type is not bound directly to 3066 // an argument expression, the conversion sequence is the one 3067 // required to convert the argument expression to the 3068 // underlying type of the reference according to 3069 // 13.3.3.1. Conceptually, this conversion sequence corresponds 3070 // to copy-initializing a temporary of the underlying type with 3071 // the argument expression. Any difference in top-level 3072 // cv-qualification is subsumed by the initialization itself 3073 // and does not constitute a conversion. 3074 ICS = TryImplicitConversion(S, Init, T1, SuppressUserConversions, 3075 /*AllowExplicit=*/false, 3076 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false); 3077 3078 // Of course, that's still a reference binding. 3079 if (ICS.isStandard()) { 3080 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true; 3081 ICS.Standard.RRefBinding = isRValRef; 3082 } else if (ICS.isUserDefined()) { 3083 ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding = true; 3084 ICS.UserDefined.After.RRefBinding = isRValRef; 3085 } 3086 return ICS; 3087} 3088 3089/// TryCopyInitialization - Try to copy-initialize a value of type 3090/// ToType from the expression From. Return the implicit conversion 3091/// sequence required to pass this argument, which may be a bad 3092/// conversion sequence (meaning that the argument cannot be passed to 3093/// a parameter of this type). If @p SuppressUserConversions, then we 3094/// do not permit any user-defined conversion sequences. 3095static ImplicitConversionSequence 3096TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 3097 bool SuppressUserConversions, 3098 bool InOverloadResolution) { 3099 if (ToType->isReferenceType()) 3100 return TryReferenceInit(S, From, ToType, 3101 /*FIXME:*/From->getLocStart(), 3102 SuppressUserConversions, 3103 /*AllowExplicit=*/false); 3104 3105 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, ToType, 3106 SuppressUserConversions, 3107 /*AllowExplicit=*/false, 3108 InOverloadResolution); 3109} 3110 3111/// TryObjectArgumentInitialization - Try to initialize the object 3112/// parameter of the given member function (@c Method) from the 3113/// expression @p From. 3114static ImplicitConversionSequence 3115TryObjectArgumentInitialization(Sema &S, QualType OrigFromType, 3116 CXXMethodDecl *Method, 3117 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext) { 3118 QualType ClassType = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(ActingContext); 3119 // [class.dtor]p2: A destructor can be invoked for a const, volatile or 3120 // const volatile object. 3121 unsigned Quals = isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(Method) ? 3122 Qualifiers::Const | Qualifiers::Volatile : Method->getTypeQualifiers(); 3123 QualType ImplicitParamType = S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(ClassType, Quals); 3124 3125 // Set up the conversion sequence as a "bad" conversion, to allow us 3126 // to exit early. 3127 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 3128 3129 // We need to have an object of class type. 3130 QualType FromType = OrigFromType; 3131 if (const PointerType *PT = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) 3132 FromType = PT->getPointeeType(); 3133 3134 assert(FromType->isRecordType()); 3135 3136 // The implicit object parameter is has the type "reference to cv X", 3137 // where X is the class of which the function is a member 3138 // (C++ [over.match.funcs]p4). However, when finding an implicit 3139 // conversion sequence for the argument, we are not allowed to 3140 // create temporaries or perform user-defined conversions 3141 // (C++ [over.match.funcs]p5). We perform a simplified version of 3142 // reference binding here, that allows class rvalues to bind to 3143 // non-constant references. 3144 3145 // First check the qualifiers. We don't care about lvalue-vs-rvalue 3146 // with the implicit object parameter (C++ [over.match.funcs]p5). 3147 QualType FromTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 3148 if (ImplicitParamType.getCVRQualifiers() 3149 != FromTypeCanon.getLocalCVRQualifiers() && 3150 !ImplicitParamType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTypeCanon)) { 3151 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers, 3152 OrigFromType, ImplicitParamType); 3153 return ICS; 3154 } 3155 3156 // Check that we have either the same type or a derived type. It 3157 // affects the conversion rank. 3158 QualType ClassTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType); 3159 ImplicitConversionKind SecondKind; 3160 if (ClassTypeCanon == FromTypeCanon.getLocalUnqualifiedType()) { 3161 SecondKind = ICK_Identity; 3162 } else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ClassType)) 3163 SecondKind = ICK_Derived_To_Base; 3164 else { 3165 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class, 3166 FromType, ImplicitParamType); 3167 return ICS; 3168 } 3169 3170 // Success. Mark this as a reference binding. 3171 ICS.setStandard(); 3172 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 3173 ICS.Standard.Second = SecondKind; 3174 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType); 3175 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ImplicitParamType); 3176 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true; 3177 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true; 3178 ICS.Standard.RRefBinding = false; 3179 return ICS; 3180} 3181 3182/// PerformObjectArgumentInitialization - Perform initialization of 3183/// the implicit object parameter for the given Method with the given 3184/// expression. 3185bool 3186Sema::PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Expr *&From, 3187 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier, 3188 NamedDecl *FoundDecl, 3189 CXXMethodDecl *Method) { 3190 QualType FromRecordType, DestType; 3191 QualType ImplicitParamRecordType = 3192 Method->getThisType(Context)->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 3193 3194 if (const PointerType *PT = From->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) { 3195 FromRecordType = PT->getPointeeType(); 3196 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context); 3197 } else { 3198 FromRecordType = From->getType(); 3199 DestType = ImplicitParamRecordType; 3200 } 3201 3202 // Note that we always use the true parent context when performing 3203 // the actual argument initialization. 3204 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS 3205 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(), Method, 3206 Method->getParent()); 3207 if (ICS.isBad()) { 3208 if (ICS.Bad.Kind == BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers) { 3209 Qualifiers FromQs = FromRecordType.getQualifiers(); 3210 Qualifiers ToQs = DestType.getQualifiers(); 3211 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers(); 3212 if (CVR) { 3213 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(), 3214 diag::err_member_function_call_bad_cvr) 3215 << Method->getDeclName() << FromRecordType << (CVR - 1) 3216 << From->getSourceRange(); 3217 Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 3218 << Method->getDeclName(); 3219 return true; 3220 } 3221 } 3222 3223 return Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(), 3224 diag::err_implicit_object_parameter_init) 3225 << ImplicitParamRecordType << FromRecordType << From->getSourceRange(); 3226 } 3227 3228 if (ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) 3229 return PerformObjectMemberConversion(From, Qualifier, FoundDecl, Method); 3230 3231 if (!Context.hasSameType(From->getType(), DestType)) 3232 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_NoOp, 3233 From->getType()->isPointerType() ? VK_RValue : VK_LValue); 3234 return false; 3235} 3236 3237/// TryContextuallyConvertToBool - Attempt to contextually convert the 3238/// expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3). 3239static ImplicitConversionSequence 3240TryContextuallyConvertToBool(Sema &S, Expr *From) { 3241 // FIXME: This is pretty broken. 3242 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, S.Context.BoolTy, 3243 // FIXME: Are these flags correct? 3244 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 3245 /*AllowExplicit=*/true, 3246 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false); 3247} 3248 3249/// PerformContextuallyConvertToBool - Perform a contextual conversion 3250/// of the expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3). 3251bool Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Expr *&From) { 3252 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, From); 3253 if (!ICS.isBad()) 3254 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Context.BoolTy, ICS, AA_Converting); 3255 3256 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, Context.BoolTy)) 3257 return Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(), 3258 diag::err_typecheck_bool_condition) 3259 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange(); 3260 return true; 3261} 3262 3263/// TryContextuallyConvertToObjCId - Attempt to contextually convert the 3264/// expression From to 'id'. 3265static ImplicitConversionSequence 3266TryContextuallyConvertToObjCId(Sema &S, Expr *From) { 3267 QualType Ty = S.Context.getObjCIdType(); 3268 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, Ty, 3269 // FIXME: Are these flags correct? 3270 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 3271 /*AllowExplicit=*/true, 3272 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false); 3273} 3274 3275/// PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCId - Perform a contextual conversion 3276/// of the expression From to 'id'. 3277bool Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCId(Expr *&From) { 3278 QualType Ty = Context.getObjCIdType(); 3279 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToObjCId(*this, From); 3280 if (!ICS.isBad()) 3281 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Ty, ICS, AA_Converting); 3282 return true; 3283} 3284 3285/// \brief Attempt to convert the given expression to an integral or 3286/// enumeration type. 3287/// 3288/// This routine will attempt to convert an expression of class type to an 3289/// integral or enumeration type, if that class type only has a single 3290/// conversion to an integral or enumeration type. 3291/// 3292/// \param Loc The source location of the construct that requires the 3293/// conversion. 3294/// 3295/// \param FromE The expression we're converting from. 3296/// 3297/// \param NotIntDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if the expression does not 3298/// have integral or enumeration type. 3299/// 3300/// \param IncompleteDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if the expression has 3301/// incomplete class type. 3302/// 3303/// \param ExplicitConvDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if we're calling an 3304/// explicit conversion function (because no implicit conversion functions 3305/// were available). This is a recovery mode. 3306/// 3307/// \param ExplicitConvNote The note to be emitted with \p ExplicitConvDiag, 3308/// showing which conversion was picked. 3309/// 3310/// \param AmbigDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if there is more than one 3311/// conversion function that could convert to integral or enumeration type. 3312/// 3313/// \param AmbigNote The note to be emitted with \p AmbigDiag for each 3314/// usable conversion function. 3315/// 3316/// \param ConvDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if we are calling a conversion 3317/// function, which may be an extension in this case. 3318/// 3319/// \returns The expression, converted to an integral or enumeration type if 3320/// successful. 3321ExprResult 3322Sema::ConvertToIntegralOrEnumerationType(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From, 3323 const PartialDiagnostic &NotIntDiag, 3324 const PartialDiagnostic &IncompleteDiag, 3325 const PartialDiagnostic &ExplicitConvDiag, 3326 const PartialDiagnostic &ExplicitConvNote, 3327 const PartialDiagnostic &AmbigDiag, 3328 const PartialDiagnostic &AmbigNote, 3329 const PartialDiagnostic &ConvDiag) { 3330 // We can't perform any more checking for type-dependent expressions. 3331 if (From->isTypeDependent()) 3332 return Owned(From); 3333 3334 // If the expression already has integral or enumeration type, we're golden. 3335 QualType T = From->getType(); 3336 if (T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) 3337 return Owned(From); 3338 3339 // FIXME: Check for missing '()' if T is a function type? 3340 3341 // If we don't have a class type in C++, there's no way we can get an 3342 // expression of integral or enumeration type. 3343 const RecordType *RecordTy = T->getAs<RecordType>(); 3344 if (!RecordTy || !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) { 3345 Diag(Loc, NotIntDiag) 3346 << T << From->getSourceRange(); 3347 return Owned(From); 3348 } 3349 3350 // We must have a complete class type. 3351 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, IncompleteDiag)) 3352 return Owned(From); 3353 3354 // Look for a conversion to an integral or enumeration type. 3355 UnresolvedSet<4> ViableConversions; 3356 UnresolvedSet<4> ExplicitConversions; 3357 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions 3358 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordTy->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 3359 3360 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(), 3361 E = Conversions->end(); 3362 I != E; 3363 ++I) { 3364 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion 3365 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl())) 3366 if (Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType() 3367 ->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) { 3368 if (Conversion->isExplicit()) 3369 ExplicitConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess()); 3370 else 3371 ViableConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess()); 3372 } 3373 } 3374 3375 switch (ViableConversions.size()) { 3376 case 0: 3377 if (ExplicitConversions.size() == 1) { 3378 DeclAccessPair Found = ExplicitConversions[0]; 3379 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion 3380 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl()); 3381 3382 // The user probably meant to invoke the given explicit 3383 // conversion; use it. 3384 QualType ConvTy 3385 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 3386 std::string TypeStr; 3387 ConvTy.getAsStringInternal(TypeStr, Context.PrintingPolicy); 3388 3389 Diag(Loc, ExplicitConvDiag) 3390 << T << ConvTy 3391 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(From->getLocStart(), 3392 "static_cast<" + TypeStr + ">(") 3393 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(PP.getLocForEndOfToken(From->getLocEnd()), 3394 ")"); 3395 Diag(Conversion->getLocation(), ExplicitConvNote) 3396 << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy; 3397 3398 // If we aren't in a SFINAE context, build a call to the 3399 // explicit conversion function. 3400 if (isSFINAEContext()) 3401 return ExprError(); 3402 3403 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found); 3404 From = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion); 3405 } 3406 3407 // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type. 3408 break; 3409 3410 case 1: { 3411 // Apply this conversion. 3412 DeclAccessPair Found = ViableConversions[0]; 3413 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found); 3414 3415 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion 3416 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl()); 3417 QualType ConvTy 3418 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 3419 if (ConvDiag.getDiagID()) { 3420 if (isSFINAEContext()) 3421 return ExprError(); 3422 3423 Diag(Loc, ConvDiag) 3424 << T << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy << From->getSourceRange(); 3425 } 3426 3427 From = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, 3428 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl())); 3429 break; 3430 } 3431 3432 default: 3433 Diag(Loc, AmbigDiag) 3434 << T << From->getSourceRange(); 3435 for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) { 3436 CXXConversionDecl *Conv 3437 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ViableConversions[I]->getUnderlyingDecl()); 3438 QualType ConvTy = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 3439 Diag(Conv->getLocation(), AmbigNote) 3440 << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy; 3441 } 3442 return Owned(From); 3443 } 3444 3445 if (!From->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) 3446 Diag(Loc, NotIntDiag) 3447 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange(); 3448 3449 return Owned(From); 3450} 3451 3452/// AddOverloadCandidate - Adds the given function to the set of 3453/// candidate functions, using the given function call arguments. If 3454/// @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't allow user-defined 3455/// conversions via constructors or conversion operators. 3456/// 3457/// \para PartialOverloading true if we are performing "partial" overloading 3458/// based on an incomplete set of function arguments. This feature is used by 3459/// code completion. 3460void 3461Sema::AddOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Function, 3462 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 3463 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs, 3464 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 3465 bool SuppressUserConversions, 3466 bool PartialOverloading) { 3467 const FunctionProtoType* Proto 3468 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()); 3469 assert(Proto && "Functions without a prototype cannot be overloaded"); 3470 assert(!Function->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() && 3471 "Use AddTemplateOverloadCandidate for function templates"); 3472 3473 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) { 3474 if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method)) { 3475 // If we get here, it's because we're calling a member function 3476 // that is named without a member access expression (e.g., 3477 // "this->f") that was either written explicitly or created 3478 // implicitly. This can happen with a qualified call to a member 3479 // function, e.g., X::f(). We use an empty type for the implied 3480 // object argument (C++ [over.call.func]p3), and the acting context 3481 // is irrelevant. 3482 AddMethodCandidate(Method, FoundDecl, Method->getParent(), 3483 QualType(), Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet, 3484 SuppressUserConversions); 3485 return; 3486 } 3487 // We treat a constructor like a non-member function, since its object 3488 // argument doesn't participate in overload resolution. 3489 } 3490 3491 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Function)) 3492 return; 3493 3494 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 3495 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated); 3496 3497 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Function)){ 3498 // C++ [class.copy]p3: 3499 // A member function template is never instantiated to perform the copy 3500 // of a class object to an object of its class type. 3501 QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Constructor->getParent()); 3502 if (NumArgs == 1 && 3503 Constructor->isSpecializationCopyingObject() && 3504 (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ClassType, Args[0]->getType()) || 3505 IsDerivedFrom(Args[0]->getType(), ClassType))) 3506 return; 3507 } 3508 3509 // Add this candidate 3510 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate()); 3511 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back(); 3512 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 3513 Candidate.Function = Function; 3514 Candidate.Viable = true; 3515 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 3516 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 3517 3518 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs(); 3519 3520 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m 3521 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter 3522 // list (8.3.5). 3523 if ((NumArgs + (PartialOverloading && NumArgs)) > NumArgsInProto && 3524 !Proto->isVariadic()) { 3525 Candidate.Viable = false; 3526 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 3527 return; 3528 } 3529 3530 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters 3531 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument 3532 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the 3533 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are 3534 // exactly m parameters. 3535 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Function->getMinRequiredArguments(); 3536 if (NumArgs < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) { 3537 // Not enough arguments. 3538 Candidate.Viable = false; 3539 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments; 3540 return; 3541 } 3542 3543 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the 3544 // arguments. 3545 Candidate.Conversions.resize(NumArgs); 3546 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 3547 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) { 3548 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall 3549 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence 3550 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding 3551 // parameter of F. 3552 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx); 3553 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx] 3554 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType, 3555 SuppressUserConversions, 3556 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true); 3557 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) { 3558 Candidate.Viable = false; 3559 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 3560 break; 3561 } 3562 } else { 3563 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any 3564 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is 3565 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3). 3566 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].setEllipsis(); 3567 } 3568 } 3569} 3570 3571/// \brief Add all of the function declarations in the given function set to 3572/// the overload canddiate set. 3573void Sema::AddFunctionCandidates(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, 3574 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs, 3575 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 3576 bool SuppressUserConversions) { 3577 for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) { 3578 NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl(); 3579 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 3580 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic()) 3581 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD), F.getPair(), 3582 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->getParent(), 3583 Args[0]->getType(), Args + 1, NumArgs - 1, 3584 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions); 3585 else 3586 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet, 3587 SuppressUserConversions); 3588 } else { 3589 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D); 3590 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl()) && 3591 !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl())->isStatic()) 3592 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(), 3593 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FunTmpl->getDeclContext()), 3594 /*FIXME: explicit args */ 0, 3595 Args[0]->getType(), Args + 1, NumArgs - 1, 3596 CandidateSet, 3597 SuppressUserConversions); 3598 else 3599 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(), 3600 /*FIXME: explicit args */ 0, 3601 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet, 3602 SuppressUserConversions); 3603 } 3604 } 3605} 3606 3607/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds a named decl (which is some kind of 3608/// method) as a method candidate to the given overload set. 3609void Sema::AddMethodCandidate(DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 3610 QualType ObjectType, 3611 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs, 3612 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 3613 bool SuppressUserConversions) { 3614 NamedDecl *Decl = FoundDecl.getDecl(); 3615 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Decl->getDeclContext()); 3616 3617 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)) 3618 Decl = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)->getTargetDecl(); 3619 3620 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Decl)) { 3621 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl()) && 3622 "Expected a member function template"); 3623 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(TD, FoundDecl, ActingContext, 3624 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0, 3625 ObjectType, Args, NumArgs, 3626 CandidateSet, 3627 SuppressUserConversions); 3628 } else { 3629 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl), FoundDecl, ActingContext, 3630 ObjectType, Args, NumArgs, 3631 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions); 3632 } 3633} 3634 3635/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds the given C++ member function to the set 3636/// of candidate functions, using the given function call arguments 3637/// and the object argument (@c Object). For example, in a call 3638/// @c o.f(a1,a2), @c Object will contain @c o and @c Args will contain 3639/// both @c a1 and @c a2. If @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't 3640/// allow user-defined conversions via constructors or conversion 3641/// operators. 3642void 3643Sema::AddMethodCandidate(CXXMethodDecl *Method, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 3644 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType, 3645 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs, 3646 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 3647 bool SuppressUserConversions) { 3648 const FunctionProtoType* Proto 3649 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()); 3650 assert(Proto && "Methods without a prototype cannot be overloaded"); 3651 assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) && 3652 "Use AddOverloadCandidate for constructors"); 3653 3654 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Method)) 3655 return; 3656 3657 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 3658 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated); 3659 3660 // Add this candidate 3661 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate()); 3662 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back(); 3663 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 3664 Candidate.Function = Method; 3665 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 3666 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 3667 3668 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs(); 3669 3670 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m 3671 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter 3672 // list (8.3.5). 3673 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) { 3674 Candidate.Viable = false; 3675 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 3676 return; 3677 } 3678 3679 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters 3680 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument 3681 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the 3682 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are 3683 // exactly m parameters. 3684 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Method->getMinRequiredArguments(); 3685 if (NumArgs < MinRequiredArgs) { 3686 // Not enough arguments. 3687 Candidate.Viable = false; 3688 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments; 3689 return; 3690 } 3691 3692 Candidate.Viable = true; 3693 Candidate.Conversions.resize(NumArgs + 1); 3694 3695 if (Method->isStatic() || ObjectType.isNull()) 3696 // The implicit object argument is ignored. 3697 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = true; 3698 else { 3699 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the object 3700 // parameter. 3701 Candidate.Conversions[0] 3702 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, ObjectType, Method, 3703 ActingContext); 3704 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) { 3705 Candidate.Viable = false; 3706 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 3707 return; 3708 } 3709 } 3710 3711 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the 3712 // arguments. 3713 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 3714 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) { 3715 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall 3716 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence 3717 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding 3718 // parameter of F. 3719 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx); 3720 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1] 3721 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType, 3722 SuppressUserConversions, 3723 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true); 3724 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) { 3725 Candidate.Viable = false; 3726 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 3727 break; 3728 } 3729 } else { 3730 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any 3731 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is 3732 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3). 3733 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis(); 3734 } 3735 } 3736} 3737 3738/// \brief Add a C++ member function template as a candidate to the candidate 3739/// set, using template argument deduction to produce an appropriate member 3740/// function template specialization. 3741void 3742Sema::AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *MethodTmpl, 3743 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 3744 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, 3745 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 3746 QualType ObjectType, 3747 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs, 3748 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 3749 bool SuppressUserConversions) { 3750 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(MethodTmpl)) 3751 return; 3752 3753 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7: 3754 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate 3755 // function template specializations are generated using template argument 3756 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as 3757 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one 3758 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template 3759 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each 3760 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate 3761 // functions. 3762 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation()); 3763 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0; 3764 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result 3765 = DeduceTemplateArguments(MethodTmpl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, 3766 Args, NumArgs, Specialization, Info)) { 3767 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate()); 3768 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.back(); 3769 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 3770 Candidate.Function = MethodTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(); 3771 Candidate.Viable = false; 3772 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction; 3773 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 3774 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 3775 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, 3776 Info); 3777 return; 3778 } 3779 3780 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument 3781 // deduction as a candidate. 3782 assert(Specialization && "Missing member function template specialization?"); 3783 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization) && 3784 "Specialization is not a member function?"); 3785 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization), FoundDecl, 3786 ActingContext, ObjectType, Args, NumArgs, 3787 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions); 3788} 3789 3790/// \brief Add a C++ function template specialization as a candidate 3791/// in the candidate set, using template argument deduction to produce 3792/// an appropriate function template specialization. 3793void 3794Sema::AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, 3795 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 3796 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 3797 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs, 3798 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 3799 bool SuppressUserConversions) { 3800 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate)) 3801 return; 3802 3803 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7: 3804 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate 3805 // function template specializations are generated using template argument 3806 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as 3807 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one 3808 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template 3809 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each 3810 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate 3811 // functions. 3812 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation()); 3813 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0; 3814 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result 3815 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ExplicitTemplateArgs, 3816 Args, NumArgs, Specialization, Info)) { 3817 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate()); 3818 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.back(); 3819 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 3820 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(); 3821 Candidate.Viable = false; 3822 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction; 3823 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 3824 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 3825 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, 3826 Info); 3827 return; 3828 } 3829 3830 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument 3831 // deduction as a candidate. 3832 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?"); 3833 AddOverloadCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet, 3834 SuppressUserConversions); 3835} 3836 3837/// AddConversionCandidate - Add a C++ conversion function as a 3838/// candidate in the candidate set (C++ [over.match.conv], 3839/// C++ [over.match.copy]). From is the expression we're converting from, 3840/// and ToType is the type that we're eventually trying to convert to 3841/// (which may or may not be the same type as the type that the 3842/// conversion function produces). 3843void 3844Sema::AddConversionCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion, 3845 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 3846 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, 3847 Expr *From, QualType ToType, 3848 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) { 3849 assert(!Conversion->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() && 3850 "Conversion function templates use AddTemplateConversionCandidate"); 3851 QualType ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 3852 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion)) 3853 return; 3854 3855 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 3856 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated); 3857 3858 // Add this candidate 3859 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate()); 3860 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back(); 3861 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 3862 Candidate.Function = Conversion; 3863 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 3864 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 3865 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAsIdentityConversion(); 3866 Candidate.FinalConversion.setFromType(ConvType); 3867 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAllToTypes(ToType); 3868 Candidate.Viable = true; 3869 Candidate.Conversions.resize(1); 3870 3871 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p4: 3872 // For conversion functions, the function is considered to be a member of 3873 // the class of the implicit implied object argument for the purpose of 3874 // defining the type of the implicit object parameter. 3875 // 3876 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit 3877 // object parameter. 3878 QualType ImplicitParamType = From->getType(); 3879 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = ImplicitParamType->getAs<PointerType>()) 3880 ImplicitParamType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(); 3881 CXXRecordDecl *ConversionContext 3882 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ImplicitParamType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()); 3883 3884 Candidate.Conversions[0] 3885 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(), Conversion, 3886 ConversionContext); 3887 3888 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) { 3889 Candidate.Viable = false; 3890 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 3891 return; 3892 } 3893 3894 // We won't go through a user-define type conversion function to convert a 3895 // derived to base as such conversions are given Conversion Rank. They only 3896 // go through a copy constructor. 13.3.3.1.2-p4 [over.ics.user] 3897 QualType FromCanon 3898 = Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType()); 3899 QualType ToCanon = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType(); 3900 if (FromCanon == ToCanon || IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon)) { 3901 Candidate.Viable = false; 3902 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_trivial_conversion; 3903 return; 3904 } 3905 3906 // To determine what the conversion from the result of calling the 3907 // conversion function to the type we're eventually trying to 3908 // convert to (ToType), we need to synthesize a call to the 3909 // conversion function and attempt copy initialization from it. This 3910 // makes sure that we get the right semantics with respect to 3911 // lvalues/rvalues and the type. Fortunately, we can allocate this 3912 // call on the stack and we don't need its arguments to be 3913 // well-formed. 3914 DeclRefExpr ConversionRef(Conversion, Conversion->getType(), 3915 VK_LValue, From->getLocStart()); 3916 ImplicitCastExpr ConversionFn(ImplicitCastExpr::OnStack, 3917 Context.getPointerType(Conversion->getType()), 3918 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay, 3919 &ConversionRef, VK_RValue); 3920 3921 QualType CallResultType 3922 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonLValueExprType(Context); 3923 if (RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), CallResultType, 0)) { 3924 Candidate.Viable = false; 3925 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion; 3926 return; 3927 } 3928 3929 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(Conversion->getConversionType()); 3930 3931 // Note that it is safe to allocate CallExpr on the stack here because 3932 // there are 0 arguments (i.e., nothing is allocated using ASTContext's 3933 // allocator). 3934 CallExpr Call(Context, &ConversionFn, 0, 0, CallResultType, VK, 3935 From->getLocStart()); 3936 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 3937 TryCopyInitialization(*this, &Call, ToType, 3938 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true, 3939 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false); 3940 3941 switch (ICS.getKind()) { 3942 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion: 3943 Candidate.FinalConversion = ICS.Standard; 3944 3945 // C++ [over.ics.user]p3: 3946 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a specialization of a 3947 // conversion function template, the second standard conversion sequence 3948 // shall have exact match rank. 3949 if (Conversion->getPrimaryTemplate() && 3950 GetConversionRank(ICS.Standard.Second) != ICR_Exact_Match) { 3951 Candidate.Viable = false; 3952 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact; 3953 } 3954 3955 break; 3956 3957 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion: 3958 Candidate.Viable = false; 3959 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion; 3960 break; 3961 3962 default: 3963 assert(false && 3964 "Can only end up with a standard conversion sequence or failure"); 3965 } 3966} 3967 3968/// \brief Adds a conversion function template specialization 3969/// candidate to the overload set, using template argument deduction 3970/// to deduce the template arguments of the conversion function 3971/// template from the type that we are converting to (C++ 3972/// [temp.deduct.conv]). 3973void 3974Sema::AddTemplateConversionCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, 3975 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 3976 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC, 3977 Expr *From, QualType ToType, 3978 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) { 3979 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()) && 3980 "Only conversion function templates permitted here"); 3981 3982 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate)) 3983 return; 3984 3985 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation()); 3986 CXXConversionDecl *Specialization = 0; 3987 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result 3988 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ToType, 3989 Specialization, Info)) { 3990 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate()); 3991 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.back(); 3992 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 3993 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(); 3994 Candidate.Viable = false; 3995 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction; 3996 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 3997 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 3998 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, 3999 Info); 4000 return; 4001 } 4002 4003 // Add the conversion function template specialization produced by 4004 // template argument deduction as a candidate. 4005 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?"); 4006 AddConversionCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, ActingDC, From, ToType, 4007 CandidateSet); 4008} 4009 4010/// AddSurrogateCandidate - Adds a "surrogate" candidate function that 4011/// converts the given @c Object to a function pointer via the 4012/// conversion function @c Conversion, and then attempts to call it 4013/// with the given arguments (C++ [over.call.object]p2-4). Proto is 4014/// the type of function that we'll eventually be calling. 4015void Sema::AddSurrogateCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion, 4016 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 4017 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, 4018 const FunctionProtoType *Proto, 4019 QualType ObjectType, 4020 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs, 4021 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) { 4022 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion)) 4023 return; 4024 4025 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 4026 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated); 4027 4028 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate()); 4029 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back(); 4030 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 4031 Candidate.Function = 0; 4032 Candidate.Surrogate = Conversion; 4033 Candidate.Viable = true; 4034 Candidate.IsSurrogate = true; 4035 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 4036 Candidate.Conversions.resize(NumArgs + 1); 4037 4038 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit 4039 // object parameter. 4040 ImplicitConversionSequence ObjectInit 4041 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, ObjectType, Conversion, 4042 ActingContext); 4043 if (ObjectInit.isBad()) { 4044 Candidate.Viable = false; 4045 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 4046 Candidate.Conversions[0] = ObjectInit; 4047 return; 4048 } 4049 4050 // The first conversion is actually a user-defined conversion whose 4051 // first conversion is ObjectInit's standard conversion (which is 4052 // effectively a reference binding). Record it as such. 4053 Candidate.Conversions[0].setUserDefined(); 4054 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before = ObjectInit.Standard; 4055 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false; 4056 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Conversion; 4057 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After 4058 = Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before; 4059 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion(); 4060 4061 // Find the 4062 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs(); 4063 4064 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m 4065 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter 4066 // list (8.3.5). 4067 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) { 4068 Candidate.Viable = false; 4069 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 4070 return; 4071 } 4072 4073 // Function types don't have any default arguments, so just check if 4074 // we have enough arguments. 4075 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) { 4076 // Not enough arguments. 4077 Candidate.Viable = false; 4078 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments; 4079 return; 4080 } 4081 4082 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the 4083 // arguments. 4084 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 4085 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) { 4086 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall 4087 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence 4088 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding 4089 // parameter of F. 4090 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx); 4091 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1] 4092 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType, 4093 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 4094 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false); 4095 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) { 4096 Candidate.Viable = false; 4097 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 4098 break; 4099 } 4100 } else { 4101 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any 4102 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is 4103 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3). 4104 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis(); 4105 } 4106 } 4107} 4108 4109/// \brief Add overload candidates for overloaded operators that are 4110/// member functions. 4111/// 4112/// Add the overloaded operator candidates that are member functions 4113/// for the operator Op that was used in an operator expression such 4114/// as "x Op y". , Args/NumArgs provides the operator arguments, and 4115/// CandidateSet will store the added overload candidates. (C++ 4116/// [over.match.oper]). 4117void Sema::AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op, 4118 SourceLocation OpLoc, 4119 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs, 4120 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 4121 SourceRange OpRange) { 4122 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 4123 4124 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 4125 // For a unary operator @ with an operand of a type whose 4126 // cv-unqualified version is T1, and for a binary operator @ with 4127 // a left operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T1 and 4128 // a right operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T2, 4129 // three sets of candidate functions, designated member 4130 // candidates, non-member candidates and built-in candidates, are 4131 // constructed as follows: 4132 QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType(); 4133 4134 // -- If T1 is a class type, the set of member candidates is the 4135 // result of the qualified lookup of T1::operator@ 4136 // (13.3.1.1.1); otherwise, the set of member candidates is 4137 // empty. 4138 if (const RecordType *T1Rec = T1->getAs<RecordType>()) { 4139 // Complete the type if it can be completed. Otherwise, we're done. 4140 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, T1, PDiag())) 4141 return; 4142 4143 LookupResult Operators(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 4144 LookupQualifiedName(Operators, T1Rec->getDecl()); 4145 Operators.suppressDiagnostics(); 4146 4147 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = Operators.begin(), 4148 OperEnd = Operators.end(); 4149 Oper != OperEnd; 4150 ++Oper) 4151 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Args[0]->getType(), 4152 Args + 1, NumArgs - 1, CandidateSet, 4153 /* SuppressUserConversions = */ false); 4154 } 4155} 4156 4157/// AddBuiltinCandidate - Add a candidate for a built-in 4158/// operator. ResultTy and ParamTys are the result and parameter types 4159/// of the built-in candidate, respectively. Args and NumArgs are the 4160/// arguments being passed to the candidate. IsAssignmentOperator 4161/// should be true when this built-in candidate is an assignment 4162/// operator. NumContextualBoolArguments is the number of arguments 4163/// (at the beginning of the argument list) that will be contextually 4164/// converted to bool. 4165void Sema::AddBuiltinCandidate(QualType ResultTy, QualType *ParamTys, 4166 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs, 4167 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 4168 bool IsAssignmentOperator, 4169 unsigned NumContextualBoolArguments) { 4170 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 4171 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated); 4172 4173 // Add this candidate 4174 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate()); 4175 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back(); 4176 Candidate.FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_none); 4177 Candidate.Function = 0; 4178 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 4179 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 4180 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ResultTy = ResultTy; 4181 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) 4182 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ArgIdx] = ParamTys[ArgIdx]; 4183 4184 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the 4185 // arguments. 4186 Candidate.Viable = true; 4187 Candidate.Conversions.resize(NumArgs); 4188 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 4189 // C++ [over.match.oper]p4: 4190 // For the built-in assignment operators, conversions of the 4191 // left operand are restricted as follows: 4192 // -- no temporaries are introduced to hold the left operand, and 4193 // -- no user-defined conversions are applied to the left 4194 // operand to achieve a type match with the left-most 4195 // parameter of a built-in candidate. 4196 // 4197 // We block these conversions by turning off user-defined 4198 // conversions, since that is the only way that initialization of 4199 // a reference to a non-class type can occur from something that 4200 // is not of the same type. 4201 if (ArgIdx < NumContextualBoolArguments) { 4202 assert(ParamTys[ArgIdx] == Context.BoolTy && 4203 "Contextual conversion to bool requires bool type"); 4204 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx] 4205 = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, Args[ArgIdx]); 4206 } else { 4207 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx] 4208 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTys[ArgIdx], 4209 ArgIdx == 0 && IsAssignmentOperator, 4210 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false); 4211 } 4212 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) { 4213 Candidate.Viable = false; 4214 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 4215 break; 4216 } 4217 } 4218} 4219 4220/// BuiltinCandidateTypeSet - A set of types that will be used for the 4221/// candidate operator functions for built-in operators (C++ 4222/// [over.built]). The types are separated into pointer types and 4223/// enumeration types. 4224class BuiltinCandidateTypeSet { 4225 /// TypeSet - A set of types. 4226 typedef llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> TypeSet; 4227 4228 /// PointerTypes - The set of pointer types that will be used in the 4229 /// built-in candidates. 4230 TypeSet PointerTypes; 4231 4232 /// MemberPointerTypes - The set of member pointer types that will be 4233 /// used in the built-in candidates. 4234 TypeSet MemberPointerTypes; 4235 4236 /// EnumerationTypes - The set of enumeration types that will be 4237 /// used in the built-in candidates. 4238 TypeSet EnumerationTypes; 4239 4240 /// \brief The set of vector types that will be used in the built-in 4241 /// candidates. 4242 TypeSet VectorTypes; 4243 4244 /// Sema - The semantic analysis instance where we are building the 4245 /// candidate type set. 4246 Sema &SemaRef; 4247 4248 /// Context - The AST context in which we will build the type sets. 4249 ASTContext &Context; 4250 4251 bool AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty, 4252 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals); 4253 bool AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty); 4254 4255public: 4256 /// iterator - Iterates through the types that are part of the set. 4257 typedef TypeSet::iterator iterator; 4258 4259 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(Sema &SemaRef) 4260 : SemaRef(SemaRef), Context(SemaRef.Context) { } 4261 4262 void AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty, 4263 SourceLocation Loc, 4264 bool AllowUserConversions, 4265 bool AllowExplicitConversions, 4266 const Qualifiers &VisibleTypeConversionsQuals); 4267 4268 /// pointer_begin - First pointer type found; 4269 iterator pointer_begin() { return PointerTypes.begin(); } 4270 4271 /// pointer_end - Past the last pointer type found; 4272 iterator pointer_end() { return PointerTypes.end(); } 4273 4274 /// member_pointer_begin - First member pointer type found; 4275 iterator member_pointer_begin() { return MemberPointerTypes.begin(); } 4276 4277 /// member_pointer_end - Past the last member pointer type found; 4278 iterator member_pointer_end() { return MemberPointerTypes.end(); } 4279 4280 /// enumeration_begin - First enumeration type found; 4281 iterator enumeration_begin() { return EnumerationTypes.begin(); } 4282 4283 /// enumeration_end - Past the last enumeration type found; 4284 iterator enumeration_end() { return EnumerationTypes.end(); } 4285 4286 iterator vector_begin() { return VectorTypes.begin(); } 4287 iterator vector_end() { return VectorTypes.end(); } 4288}; 4289 4290/// AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty to 4291/// the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of 4292/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine 4293/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const 4294/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of 4295/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded, 4296/// false otherwise. 4297/// 4298/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers? 4299bool 4300BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty, 4301 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) { 4302 4303 // Insert this type. 4304 if (!PointerTypes.insert(Ty)) 4305 return false; 4306 4307 QualType PointeeTy; 4308 const PointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<PointerType>(); 4309 bool buildObjCPtr = false; 4310 if (!PointerTy) { 4311 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 4312 PointeeTy = PTy->getPointeeType(); 4313 buildObjCPtr = true; 4314 } 4315 else 4316 assert(false && "type was not a pointer type!"); 4317 } 4318 else 4319 PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType(); 4320 4321 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed 4322 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the 4323 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int, 4324 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway. 4325 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType()) 4326 return true; 4327 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers(); 4328 if (const ConstantArrayType *Array =Context.getAsConstantArrayType(PointeeTy)) 4329 BaseCVR = Array->getElementType().getCVRQualifiers(); 4330 bool hasVolatile = VisibleQuals.hasVolatile(); 4331 bool hasRestrict = VisibleQuals.hasRestrict(); 4332 4333 // Iterate through all strict supersets of BaseCVR. 4334 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) { 4335 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue; 4336 // Skip over Volatile/Restrict if no Volatile/Restrict found anywhere 4337 // in the types. 4338 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Volatile) && !hasVolatile) continue; 4339 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Restrict) && !hasRestrict) continue; 4340 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR); 4341 if (!buildObjCPtr) 4342 PointerTypes.insert(Context.getPointerType(QPointeeTy)); 4343 else 4344 PointerTypes.insert(Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QPointeeTy)); 4345 } 4346 4347 return true; 4348} 4349 4350/// AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty 4351/// to the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of 4352/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine 4353/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const 4354/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of 4355/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded, 4356/// false otherwise. 4357/// 4358/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers? 4359bool 4360BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants( 4361 QualType Ty) { 4362 // Insert this type. 4363 if (!MemberPointerTypes.insert(Ty)) 4364 return false; 4365 4366 const MemberPointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 4367 assert(PointerTy && "type was not a member pointer type!"); 4368 4369 QualType PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType(); 4370 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed 4371 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the 4372 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int, 4373 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway. 4374 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType()) 4375 return true; 4376 const Type *ClassTy = PointerTy->getClass(); 4377 4378 // Iterate through all strict supersets of the pointee type's CVR 4379 // qualifiers. 4380 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers(); 4381 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) { 4382 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue; 4383 4384 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR); 4385 MemberPointerTypes.insert(Context.getMemberPointerType(QPointeeTy, ClassTy)); 4386 } 4387 4388 return true; 4389} 4390 4391/// AddTypesConvertedFrom - Add each of the types to which the type @p 4392/// Ty can be implicit converted to the given set of @p Types. We're 4393/// primarily interested in pointer types and enumeration types. We also 4394/// take member pointer types, for the conditional operator. 4395/// AllowUserConversions is true if we should look at the conversion 4396/// functions of a class type, and AllowExplicitConversions if we 4397/// should also include the explicit conversion functions of a class 4398/// type. 4399void 4400BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty, 4401 SourceLocation Loc, 4402 bool AllowUserConversions, 4403 bool AllowExplicitConversions, 4404 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) { 4405 // Only deal with canonical types. 4406 Ty = Context.getCanonicalType(Ty); 4407 4408 // Look through reference types; they aren't part of the type of an 4409 // expression for the purposes of conversions. 4410 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Ty->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 4411 Ty = RefTy->getPointeeType(); 4412 4413 // We don't care about qualifiers on the type. 4414 Ty = Ty.getLocalUnqualifiedType(); 4415 4416 // If we're dealing with an array type, decay to the pointer. 4417 if (Ty->isArrayType()) 4418 Ty = SemaRef.Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty); 4419 if (Ty->isObjCIdType() || Ty->isObjCClassType()) 4420 PointerTypes.insert(Ty); 4421 else if (Ty->getAs<PointerType>() || Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 4422 // Insert our type, and its more-qualified variants, into the set 4423 // of types. 4424 if (!AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty, VisibleQuals)) 4425 return; 4426 } else if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) { 4427 // Member pointers are far easier, since the pointee can't be converted. 4428 if (!AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty)) 4429 return; 4430 } else if (Ty->isEnumeralType()) { 4431 EnumerationTypes.insert(Ty); 4432 } else if (Ty->isVectorType()) { 4433 VectorTypes.insert(Ty); 4434 } else if (AllowUserConversions) { 4435 if (const RecordType *TyRec = Ty->getAs<RecordType>()) { 4436 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(Loc, Ty, 0)) { 4437 // No conversion functions in incomplete types. 4438 return; 4439 } 4440 4441 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl()); 4442 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions 4443 = ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 4444 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(), 4445 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) { 4446 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl(); 4447 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 4448 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 4449 4450 // Skip conversion function templates; they don't tell us anything 4451 // about which builtin types we can convert to. 4452 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)) 4453 continue; 4454 4455 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 4456 if (AllowExplicitConversions || !Conv->isExplicit()) { 4457 AddTypesConvertedFrom(Conv->getConversionType(), Loc, false, false, 4458 VisibleQuals); 4459 } 4460 } 4461 } 4462 } 4463} 4464 4465/// \brief Helper function for AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates() that adds 4466/// the volatile- and non-volatile-qualified assignment operators for the 4467/// given type to the candidate set. 4468static void AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(Sema &S, 4469 QualType T, 4470 Expr **Args, 4471 unsigned NumArgs, 4472 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) { 4473 QualType ParamTypes[2]; 4474 4475 // T& operator=(T&, T) 4476 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T); 4477 ParamTypes[1] = T; 4478 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet, 4479 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true); 4480 4481 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(T).isVolatileQualified()) { 4482 // volatile T& operator=(volatile T&, T) 4483 ParamTypes[0] 4484 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(T)); 4485 ParamTypes[1] = T; 4486 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet, 4487 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true); 4488 } 4489} 4490 4491/// CollectVRQualifiers - This routine returns Volatile/Restrict qualifiers, 4492/// if any, found in visible type conversion functions found in ArgExpr's type. 4493static Qualifiers CollectVRQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, Expr* ArgExpr) { 4494 Qualifiers VRQuals; 4495 const RecordType *TyRec; 4496 if (const MemberPointerType *RHSMPType = 4497 ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) 4498 TyRec = RHSMPType->getClass()->getAs<RecordType>(); 4499 else 4500 TyRec = ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<RecordType>(); 4501 if (!TyRec) { 4502 // Just to be safe, assume the worst case. 4503 VRQuals.addVolatile(); 4504 VRQuals.addRestrict(); 4505 return VRQuals; 4506 } 4507 4508 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl()); 4509 if (!ClassDecl->hasDefinition()) 4510 return VRQuals; 4511 4512 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions = 4513 ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 4514 4515 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(), 4516 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) { 4517 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl(); 4518 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 4519 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 4520 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conv = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D)) { 4521 QualType CanTy = Context.getCanonicalType(Conv->getConversionType()); 4522 if (const ReferenceType *ResTypeRef = CanTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 4523 CanTy = ResTypeRef->getPointeeType(); 4524 // Need to go down the pointer/mempointer chain and add qualifiers 4525 // as see them. 4526 bool done = false; 4527 while (!done) { 4528 if (const PointerType *ResTypePtr = CanTy->getAs<PointerType>()) 4529 CanTy = ResTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 4530 else if (const MemberPointerType *ResTypeMPtr = 4531 CanTy->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) 4532 CanTy = ResTypeMPtr->getPointeeType(); 4533 else 4534 done = true; 4535 if (CanTy.isVolatileQualified()) 4536 VRQuals.addVolatile(); 4537 if (CanTy.isRestrictQualified()) 4538 VRQuals.addRestrict(); 4539 if (VRQuals.hasRestrict() && VRQuals.hasVolatile()) 4540 return VRQuals; 4541 } 4542 } 4543 } 4544 return VRQuals; 4545} 4546 4547 4548/// AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates - Add the appropriate built-in 4549/// operator overloads to the candidate set (C++ [over.built]), based 4550/// on the operator @p Op and the arguments given. For example, if the 4551/// operator is a binary '+', this routine might add "int 4552/// operator+(int, int)" to cover integer addition. 4553void 4554Sema::AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op, 4555 SourceLocation OpLoc, 4556 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs, 4557 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) { 4558 // Information about arithmetic types useful to builtin-type 4559 // calculations. 4560 4561 // The "promoted arithmetic types" are the arithmetic 4562 // types are that preserved by promotion (C++ [over.built]p2). 4563 4564 static const unsigned FirstIntegralType = 3; 4565 static const unsigned LastIntegralType = 18; 4566 static const unsigned FirstPromotedIntegralType = 3, 4567 LastPromotedIntegralType = 9; 4568 static const unsigned FirstPromotedArithmeticType = 0, 4569 LastPromotedArithmeticType = 9; 4570 static const unsigned NumArithmeticTypes = 18; 4571 4572 static CanQualType ASTContext::* const ArithmeticTypes[NumArithmeticTypes] = { 4573 // Start of promoted types. 4574 &ASTContext::FloatTy, 4575 &ASTContext::DoubleTy, 4576 &ASTContext::LongDoubleTy, 4577 4578 // Start of integral types. 4579 &ASTContext::IntTy, 4580 &ASTContext::LongTy, 4581 &ASTContext::LongLongTy, 4582 &ASTContext::UnsignedIntTy, 4583 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongTy, 4584 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongLongTy, 4585 // End of promoted types. 4586 4587 &ASTContext::BoolTy, 4588 &ASTContext::CharTy, 4589 &ASTContext::WCharTy, 4590 &ASTContext::Char16Ty, 4591 &ASTContext::Char32Ty, 4592 &ASTContext::SignedCharTy, 4593 &ASTContext::ShortTy, 4594 &ASTContext::UnsignedCharTy, 4595 &ASTContext::UnsignedShortTy 4596 // End of integral types. 4597 }; 4598 // FIXME: What about complex? 4599 assert(ArithmeticTypes[FirstPromotedIntegralType] == &ASTContext::IntTy && 4600 "Invalid first promoted integral type"); 4601 assert(ArithmeticTypes[LastPromotedIntegralType - 1] 4602 == &ASTContext::UnsignedLongLongTy && 4603 "Invalid last promoted integral type"); 4604 assert(ArithmeticTypes[FirstPromotedArithmeticType] == &ASTContext::FloatTy && 4605 "Invalid first promoted arithmetic type"); 4606 assert(ArithmeticTypes[LastPromotedArithmeticType - 1] 4607 == &ASTContext::UnsignedLongLongTy && 4608 "Invalid last promoted arithmetic type"); 4609 4610 // Accelerator table for performing the usual arithmetic conversions. 4611 // The rules are basically: 4612 // - if either is floating-point, use the wider floating-point 4613 // - if same signedness, use the higher rank 4614 // - if same size, use unsigned of the higher rank 4615 // - use the larger type 4616 // These rules, together with the axiom that higher ranks are 4617 // never smaller, are sufficient to precompute all of these results 4618 // *except* when dealing with signed types of higher rank. 4619 // (we could precompute SLL x UI for all known platforms, but it's 4620 // better not to make any assumptions). 4621 enum PromT { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, UI, UL, ULL, Dep=-1 }; 4622 static PromT UsualArithmeticConversionsTypes 4623 [LastPromotedArithmeticType][LastPromotedArithmeticType] = { 4624 /* Flt*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt }, 4625 /* Dbl*/ { Dbl, Dbl, LDbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl }, 4626 /*LDbl*/ { LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl }, 4627 /* SI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, UI, UL, ULL }, 4628 /* SL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SL, SL, SLL, Dep, UL, ULL }, 4629 /* SLL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SLL, SLL, SLL, Dep, Dep, ULL }, 4630 /* UI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UI, Dep, Dep, UI, UL, ULL }, 4631 /* UL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UL, UL, Dep, UL, UL, ULL }, 4632 /* ULL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, ULL, ULL, ULL, ULL, ULL, ULL } 4633 }; 4634 struct UsualArithmeticConversionsType { 4635 static CanQualType find(ASTContext &C, unsigned L, unsigned R) { 4636 assert(L < LastPromotedArithmeticType); 4637 assert(R < LastPromotedArithmeticType); 4638 signed char Idx = UsualArithmeticConversionsTypes[L][R]; 4639 4640 // Fast path: the table gives us a concrete answer. 4641 if (Idx != Dep) return C.*ArithmeticTypes[Idx]; 4642 4643 // Slow path: we need to compare widths. 4644 // An invariant is that the signed type has higher rank. 4645 CanQualType LT = C.*ArithmeticTypes[L], RT = C.*ArithmeticTypes[R]; 4646 unsigned LW = C.getIntWidth(LT), RW = C.getIntWidth(RT); 4647 4648 // If they're different widths, use the signed type. 4649 if (LW > RW) return LT; 4650 else if (LW > RW) return RT; 4651 4652 // Otherwise, use the unsigned type of the signed type's rank. 4653 if (L == SL || R == SL) return C.UnsignedLongTy; 4654 assert(L == SLL || R == SLL); 4655 return C.UnsignedLongLongTy; 4656 } 4657 }; 4658 4659 // Find all of the types that the arguments can convert to, but only 4660 // if the operator we're looking at has built-in operator candidates 4661 // that make use of these types. 4662 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals; 4663 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.addConst(); 4664 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) 4665 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals += CollectVRQualifiers(Context, Args[ArgIdx]); 4666 4667 llvm::SmallVector<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet, 2> CandidateTypes; 4668 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 4669 CandidateTypes.push_back(BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(*this)); 4670 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].AddTypesConvertedFrom(Args[ArgIdx]->getType(), 4671 OpLoc, 4672 true, 4673 (Op == OO_Exclaim || 4674 Op == OO_AmpAmp || 4675 Op == OO_PipePipe), 4676 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals); 4677 } 4678 4679 // C++ [over.built]p1: 4680 // If there is a user-written candidate with the same name and parameter 4681 // types as a built-in candidate operator function, the built-in operator 4682 // function is hidden and is not included in the set of candidate functions. 4683 // 4684 // The text is actually in a note, but if we don't implement it then we end 4685 // up with ambiguities when the user provides an overloaded operator for 4686 // an enumeration type. Note that only enumeration types have this problem, 4687 // so we track which enumeration types we've seen operators for. 4688 llvm::DenseSet<std::pair<CanQualType, CanQualType> > 4689 UserDefinedBinaryOperators; 4690 4691 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 4692 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 4693 4694 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 4695 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin() 4696 != CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end()) { 4697 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator C = CandidateSet.begin(), 4698 CEnd = CandidateSet.end(); 4699 C != CEnd; ++C) { 4700 if (!C->Viable || !C->Function || C->Function->getNumParams() != 2) 4701 continue; 4702 4703 // Check if the first parameter is of enumeration type. 4704 QualType FirstParamType 4705 = C->Function->getParamDecl(0)->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 4706 if (!FirstParamType->isEnumeralType()) 4707 continue; 4708 4709 // Check if the second parameter is of enumeration type. 4710 QualType SecondParamType 4711 = C->Function->getParamDecl(1)->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 4712 if (!SecondParamType->isEnumeralType()) 4713 continue; 4714 4715 // Add this operator to the set of known user-defined operators. 4716 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.insert( 4717 std::make_pair(Context.getCanonicalType(FirstParamType), 4718 Context.getCanonicalType(SecondParamType))); 4719 } 4720 } 4721 } 4722 4723 bool isComparison = false; 4724 switch (Op) { 4725 case OO_None: 4726 case NUM_OVERLOADED_OPERATORS: 4727 assert(false && "Expected an overloaded operator"); 4728 break; 4729 4730 case OO_Star: // '*' is either unary or binary 4731 if (NumArgs == 1) 4732 goto UnaryStar; 4733 else 4734 goto BinaryStar; 4735 break; 4736 4737 case OO_Plus: // '+' is either unary or binary 4738 if (NumArgs == 1) 4739 goto UnaryPlus; 4740 else 4741 goto BinaryPlus; 4742 break; 4743 4744 case OO_Minus: // '-' is either unary or binary 4745 if (NumArgs == 1) 4746 goto UnaryMinus; 4747 else 4748 goto BinaryMinus; 4749 break; 4750 4751 case OO_Amp: // '&' is either unary or binary 4752 if (NumArgs == 1) 4753 goto UnaryAmp; 4754 else 4755 goto BinaryAmp; 4756 4757 case OO_PlusPlus: 4758 case OO_MinusMinus: 4759 // C++ [over.built]p3: 4760 // 4761 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type, and VQ 4762 // is either volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator 4763 // functions of the form 4764 // 4765 // VQ T& operator++(VQ T&); 4766 // T operator++(VQ T&, int); 4767 // 4768 // C++ [over.built]p4: 4769 // 4770 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other 4771 // than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist 4772 // candidate operator functions of the form 4773 // 4774 // VQ T& operator--(VQ T&); 4775 // T operator--(VQ T&, int); 4776 for (unsigned Arith = (Op == OO_PlusPlus? 0 : 1); 4777 Arith < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Arith) { 4778 QualType ArithTy = Context.*ArithmeticTypes[Arith]; 4779 QualType ParamTypes[2] 4780 = { Context.getLValueReferenceType(ArithTy), Context.IntTy }; 4781 4782 // Non-volatile version. 4783 if (NumArgs == 1) 4784 AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet); 4785 else 4786 AddBuiltinCandidate(ArithTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 4787 // heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set. 4788 // Add volatile version only if there are conversions to a volatile type. 4789 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) { 4790 // Volatile version 4791 ParamTypes[0] 4792 = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Context.getVolatileType(ArithTy)); 4793 if (NumArgs == 1) 4794 AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet); 4795 else 4796 AddBuiltinCandidate(ArithTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 4797 } 4798 } 4799 4800 // C++ [over.built]p5: 4801 // 4802 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or 4803 // cv-unqualified object type, and VQ is either volatile or 4804 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 4805 // 4806 // T*VQ& operator++(T*VQ&); 4807 // T*VQ& operator--(T*VQ&); 4808 // T* operator++(T*VQ&, int); 4809 // T* operator--(T*VQ&, int); 4810 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 4811 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 4812 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 4813 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 4814 // Skip pointer types that aren't pointers to object types. 4815 if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) 4816 continue; 4817 4818 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { 4819 Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr), Context.IntTy 4820 }; 4821 4822 // Without volatile 4823 if (NumArgs == 1) 4824 AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet); 4825 else 4826 AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 4827 4828 if (!Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() && 4829 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) { 4830 // With volatile 4831 ParamTypes[0] 4832 = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr)); 4833 if (NumArgs == 1) 4834 AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet); 4835 else 4836 AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 4837 } 4838 } 4839 break; 4840 4841 UnaryStar: 4842 // C++ [over.built]p6: 4843 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T, there 4844 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 4845 // 4846 // T& operator*(T*); 4847 // 4848 // C++ [over.built]p7: 4849 // For every function type T, there exist candidate operator 4850 // functions of the form 4851 // T& operator*(T*); 4852 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 4853 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 4854 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 4855 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 4856 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr; 4857 QualType PointeeTy = ParamTy->getPointeeType(); 4858 AddBuiltinCandidate(Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeTy), 4859 &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet); 4860 } 4861 break; 4862 4863 UnaryPlus: 4864 // C++ [over.built]p8: 4865 // For every type T, there exist candidate operator functions of 4866 // the form 4867 // 4868 // T* operator+(T*); 4869 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 4870 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 4871 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 4872 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 4873 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr; 4874 AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet); 4875 } 4876 4877 // Fall through 4878 4879 UnaryMinus: 4880 // C++ [over.built]p9: 4881 // For every promoted arithmetic type T, there exist candidate 4882 // operator functions of the form 4883 // 4884 // T operator+(T); 4885 // T operator-(T); 4886 for (unsigned Arith = FirstPromotedArithmeticType; 4887 Arith < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Arith) { 4888 QualType ArithTy = Context.*ArithmeticTypes[Arith]; 4889 AddBuiltinCandidate(ArithTy, &ArithTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet); 4890 } 4891 4892 // Extension: We also add these operators for vector types. 4893 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 4894 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(), 4895 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end(); 4896 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) { 4897 QualType VecTy = *Vec; 4898 AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet); 4899 } 4900 break; 4901 4902 case OO_Tilde: 4903 // C++ [over.built]p10: 4904 // For every promoted integral type T, there exist candidate 4905 // operator functions of the form 4906 // 4907 // T operator~(T); 4908 for (unsigned Int = FirstPromotedIntegralType; 4909 Int < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Int) { 4910 QualType IntTy = Context.*ArithmeticTypes[Int]; 4911 AddBuiltinCandidate(IntTy, &IntTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet); 4912 } 4913 4914 // Extension: We also add this operator for vector types. 4915 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 4916 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(), 4917 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end(); 4918 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) { 4919 QualType VecTy = *Vec; 4920 AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet); 4921 } 4922 break; 4923 4924 case OO_New: 4925 case OO_Delete: 4926 case OO_Array_New: 4927 case OO_Array_Delete: 4928 case OO_Call: 4929 assert(false && "Special operators don't use AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates"); 4930 break; 4931 4932 case OO_Comma: 4933 UnaryAmp: 4934 case OO_Arrow: 4935 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 4936 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the 4937 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty. 4938 break; 4939 4940 case OO_EqualEqual: 4941 case OO_ExclaimEqual: 4942 // C++ [over.match.oper]p16: 4943 // For every pointer to member type T, there exist candidate operator 4944 // functions of the form 4945 // 4946 // bool operator==(T,T); 4947 // bool operator!=(T,T); 4948 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 4949 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 4950 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(), 4951 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end(); 4952 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; 4953 ++MemPtr) { 4954 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice. 4955 if (!AddedTypes.insert(Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr))) 4956 continue; 4957 4958 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr }; 4959 AddBuiltinCandidate(Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 4960 } 4961 } 4962 AddedTypes.clear(); 4963 4964 // Fall through 4965 4966 case OO_Less: 4967 case OO_Greater: 4968 case OO_LessEqual: 4969 case OO_GreaterEqual: 4970 // C++ [over.built]p15: 4971 // 4972 // For every pointer or enumeration type T, there exist 4973 // candidate operator functions of the form 4974 // 4975 // bool operator<(T, T); 4976 // bool operator>(T, T); 4977 // bool operator<=(T, T); 4978 // bool operator>=(T, T); 4979 // bool operator==(T, T); 4980 // bool operator!=(T, T); 4981 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 4982 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 4983 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(), 4984 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end(); 4985 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 4986 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice. 4987 if (!AddedTypes.insert(Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr))) 4988 continue; 4989 4990 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr }; 4991 AddBuiltinCandidate(Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 4992 } 4993 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 4994 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(), 4995 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end(); 4996 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) { 4997 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice. 4998 if (!AddedTypes.insert(Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum))) 4999 continue; 5000 5001 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum }; 5002 CanQualType CanonType = Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum); 5003 if (!UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count( 5004 std::make_pair(CanonType, CanonType))) 5005 AddBuiltinCandidate(Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 5006 } 5007 } 5008 AddedTypes.clear(); 5009 5010 // Fall through. 5011 isComparison = true; 5012 5013 BinaryPlus: 5014 BinaryMinus: 5015 if (!isComparison) { 5016 // We didn't fall through, so we must have OO_Plus or OO_Minus. 5017 5018 // C++ [over.built]p13: 5019 // 5020 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T 5021 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form 5022 // 5023 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t); 5024 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t); [BELOW] 5025 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t); 5026 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); 5027 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*); [BELOW] 5028 // 5029 // C++ [over.built]p14: 5030 // 5031 // For every T, where T is a pointer to object type, there 5032 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 5033 // 5034 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T); 5035 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 5036 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 5037 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 5038 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 5039 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, Context.getPointerDiffType() }; 5040 5041 // operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t) or operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t) 5042 AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 5043 5044 if (Op == OO_Minus) { 5045 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T); 5046 if (!AddedTypes.insert(Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr))) 5047 continue; 5048 5049 ParamTypes[1] = *Ptr; 5050 AddBuiltinCandidate(Context.getPointerDiffType(), ParamTypes, 5051 Args, 2, CandidateSet); 5052 } 5053 } 5054 5055 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 5056 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(), 5057 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end(); 5058 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 5059 if (Op == OO_Plus) { 5060 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); 5061 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { Context.getPointerDiffType(), *Ptr }; 5062 AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 5063 } else { 5064 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T); 5065 if (!AddedTypes.insert(Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr))) 5066 continue; 5067 5068 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr }; 5069 AddBuiltinCandidate(Context.getPointerDiffType(), ParamTypes, 5070 Args, 2, CandidateSet); 5071 } 5072 } 5073 5074 AddedTypes.clear(); 5075 } 5076 // Fall through 5077 5078 case OO_Slash: 5079 BinaryStar: 5080 Conditional: 5081 // C++ [over.built]p12: 5082 // 5083 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there 5084 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 5085 // 5086 // LR operator*(L, R); 5087 // LR operator/(L, R); 5088 // LR operator+(L, R); 5089 // LR operator-(L, R); 5090 // bool operator<(L, R); 5091 // bool operator>(L, R); 5092 // bool operator<=(L, R); 5093 // bool operator>=(L, R); 5094 // bool operator==(L, R); 5095 // bool operator!=(L, R); 5096 // 5097 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions 5098 // between types L and R. 5099 // 5100 // C++ [over.built]p24: 5101 // 5102 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there exist 5103 // candidate operator functions of the form 5104 // 5105 // LR operator?(bool, L, R); 5106 // 5107 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions 5108 // between types L and R. 5109 // Our candidates ignore the first parameter. 5110 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedArithmeticType; 5111 Left < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Left) { 5112 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType; 5113 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) { 5114 QualType LandR[2] = { Context.*ArithmeticTypes[Left], 5115 Context.*ArithmeticTypes[Right] }; 5116 QualType Result 5117 = isComparison 5118 ? Context.BoolTy 5119 : UsualArithmeticConversionsType::find(Context, Left, Right); 5120 AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 5121 } 5122 } 5123 5124 // Extension: Add the binary operators ==, !=, <, <=, >=, >, *, /, and the 5125 // conditional operator for vector types. 5126 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 5127 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(), 5128 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end(); 5129 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) 5130 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 5131 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(), 5132 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end(); 5133 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) { 5134 QualType LandR[2] = { *Vec1, *Vec2 }; 5135 QualType Result; 5136 if (isComparison) 5137 Result = Context.BoolTy; 5138 else { 5139 if ((*Vec1)->isExtVectorType() || !(*Vec2)->isExtVectorType()) 5140 Result = *Vec1; 5141 else 5142 Result = *Vec2; 5143 } 5144 5145 AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 5146 } 5147 5148 break; 5149 5150 case OO_Percent: 5151 BinaryAmp: 5152 case OO_Caret: 5153 case OO_Pipe: 5154 case OO_LessLess: 5155 case OO_GreaterGreater: 5156 // C++ [over.built]p17: 5157 // 5158 // For every pair of promoted integral types L and R, there 5159 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 5160 // 5161 // LR operator%(L, R); 5162 // LR operator&(L, R); 5163 // LR operator^(L, R); 5164 // LR operator|(L, R); 5165 // L operator<<(L, R); 5166 // L operator>>(L, R); 5167 // 5168 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions 5169 // between types L and R. 5170 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedIntegralType; 5171 Left < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Left) { 5172 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType; 5173 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) { 5174 QualType LandR[2] = { Context.*ArithmeticTypes[Left], 5175 Context.*ArithmeticTypes[Right] }; 5176 QualType Result = (Op == OO_LessLess || Op == OO_GreaterGreater) 5177 ? LandR[0] 5178 : UsualArithmeticConversionsType::find(Context, Left, Right); 5179 AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 5180 } 5181 } 5182 break; 5183 5184 case OO_Equal: 5185 // C++ [over.built]p20: 5186 // 5187 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an enumeration or 5188 // pointer to member type and VQ is either volatile or 5189 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 5190 // 5191 // VQ T& operator=(VQ T&, T); 5192 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 5193 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 5194 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(), 5195 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end(); 5196 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) { 5197 if (!AddedTypes.insert(Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum))) 5198 continue; 5199 5200 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(*this, *Enum, Args, 2, 5201 CandidateSet); 5202 } 5203 5204 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 5205 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(), 5206 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end(); 5207 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) { 5208 if (!AddedTypes.insert(Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr))) 5209 continue; 5210 5211 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(*this, *MemPtr, Args, 2, 5212 CandidateSet); 5213 } 5214 } 5215 AddedTypes.clear(); 5216 5217 // Fall through. 5218 5219 case OO_PlusEqual: 5220 case OO_MinusEqual: 5221 // C++ [over.built]p19: 5222 // 5223 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is any type and VQ is either 5224 // volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator functions 5225 // of the form 5226 // 5227 // T*VQ& operator=(T*VQ&, T*); 5228 // 5229 // C++ [over.built]p21: 5230 // 5231 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or 5232 // cv-unqualified object type and VQ is either volatile or 5233 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 5234 // 5235 // T*VQ& operator+=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t); 5236 // T*VQ& operator-=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t); 5237 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 5238 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 5239 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 5240 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 5241 QualType ParamTypes[2]; 5242 ParamTypes[1] = (Op == OO_Equal)? *Ptr : Context.getPointerDiffType(); 5243 5244 // If this is operator=, keep track of the builtin candidates we added. 5245 if (Op == OO_Equal) 5246 AddedTypes.insert(Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)); 5247 5248 // non-volatile version 5249 ParamTypes[0] = Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr); 5250 AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet, 5251 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/Op == OO_Equal); 5252 5253 if (!Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() && 5254 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) { 5255 // volatile version 5256 ParamTypes[0] 5257 = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr)); 5258 AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet, 5259 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/Op == OO_Equal); 5260 } 5261 } 5262 5263 if (Op == OO_Equal) { 5264 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 5265 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(), 5266 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end(); 5267 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 5268 // Make sure we don't add the same candidate twice. 5269 if (!AddedTypes.insert(Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr))) 5270 continue; 5271 5272 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr), *Ptr }; 5273 5274 // non-volatile version 5275 AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet, 5276 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true); 5277 5278 if (!Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() && 5279 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) { 5280 // volatile version 5281 ParamTypes[0] 5282 = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr)); 5283 AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet, 5284 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true); 5285 } 5286 } 5287 AddedTypes.clear(); 5288 } 5289 // Fall through. 5290 5291 case OO_StarEqual: 5292 case OO_SlashEqual: 5293 // C++ [over.built]p18: 5294 // 5295 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an arithmetic type, 5296 // VQ is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted 5297 // arithmetic type, there exist candidate operator functions of 5298 // the form 5299 // 5300 // VQ L& operator=(VQ L&, R); 5301 // VQ L& operator*=(VQ L&, R); 5302 // VQ L& operator/=(VQ L&, R); 5303 // VQ L& operator+=(VQ L&, R); 5304 // VQ L& operator-=(VQ L&, R); 5305 for (unsigned Left = 0; Left < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Left) { 5306 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType; 5307 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) { 5308 QualType ParamTypes[2]; 5309 ParamTypes[1] = Context.*ArithmeticTypes[Right]; 5310 5311 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty). 5312 ParamTypes[0] = 5313 Context.getLValueReferenceType(Context.*ArithmeticTypes[Left]); 5314 AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet, 5315 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/Op == OO_Equal); 5316 5317 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile'). 5318 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) { 5319 ParamTypes[0] = 5320 Context.getVolatileType(Context.*ArithmeticTypes[Left]); 5321 ParamTypes[0] = Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]); 5322 AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet, 5323 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/Op == OO_Equal); 5324 } 5325 } 5326 } 5327 5328 // Extension: Add the binary operators =, +=, -=, *=, /= for vector types. 5329 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 5330 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(), 5331 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end(); 5332 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) 5333 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 5334 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(), 5335 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end(); 5336 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) { 5337 QualType ParamTypes[2]; 5338 ParamTypes[1] = *Vec2; 5339 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty). 5340 ParamTypes[0] = Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Vec1); 5341 AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet, 5342 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/Op == OO_Equal); 5343 5344 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile'). 5345 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) { 5346 ParamTypes[0] = Context.getVolatileType(*Vec1); 5347 ParamTypes[0] = Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]); 5348 AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet, 5349 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/Op == OO_Equal); 5350 } 5351 } 5352 break; 5353 5354 case OO_PercentEqual: 5355 case OO_LessLessEqual: 5356 case OO_GreaterGreaterEqual: 5357 case OO_AmpEqual: 5358 case OO_CaretEqual: 5359 case OO_PipeEqual: 5360 // C++ [over.built]p22: 5361 // 5362 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an integral type, VQ 5363 // is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted integral 5364 // type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 5365 // 5366 // VQ L& operator%=(VQ L&, R); 5367 // VQ L& operator<<=(VQ L&, R); 5368 // VQ L& operator>>=(VQ L&, R); 5369 // VQ L& operator&=(VQ L&, R); 5370 // VQ L& operator^=(VQ L&, R); 5371 // VQ L& operator|=(VQ L&, R); 5372 for (unsigned Left = FirstIntegralType; Left < LastIntegralType; ++Left) { 5373 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType; 5374 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) { 5375 QualType ParamTypes[2]; 5376 ParamTypes[1] = Context.*ArithmeticTypes[Right]; 5377 5378 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty). 5379 ParamTypes[0] = 5380 Context.getLValueReferenceType(Context.*ArithmeticTypes[Left]); 5381 AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 5382 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) { 5383 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile'). 5384 ParamTypes[0] = Context.*ArithmeticTypes[Left]; 5385 ParamTypes[0] = Context.getVolatileType(ParamTypes[0]); 5386 ParamTypes[0] = Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]); 5387 AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 5388 } 5389 } 5390 } 5391 break; 5392 5393 case OO_Exclaim: { 5394 // C++ [over.operator]p23: 5395 // 5396 // There also exist candidate operator functions of the form 5397 // 5398 // bool operator!(bool); 5399 // bool operator&&(bool, bool); [BELOW] 5400 // bool operator||(bool, bool); [BELOW] 5401 QualType ParamTy = Context.BoolTy; 5402 AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet, 5403 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false, 5404 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/1); 5405 break; 5406 } 5407 5408 case OO_AmpAmp: 5409 case OO_PipePipe: { 5410 // C++ [over.operator]p23: 5411 // 5412 // There also exist candidate operator functions of the form 5413 // 5414 // bool operator!(bool); [ABOVE] 5415 // bool operator&&(bool, bool); 5416 // bool operator||(bool, bool); 5417 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { Context.BoolTy, Context.BoolTy }; 5418 AddBuiltinCandidate(Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet, 5419 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false, 5420 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/2); 5421 break; 5422 } 5423 5424 case OO_Subscript: 5425 // C++ [over.built]p13: 5426 // 5427 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T there 5428 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 5429 // 5430 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE] 5431 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t); 5432 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE] 5433 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); [ABOVE] 5434 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*); 5435 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 5436 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 5437 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 5438 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 5439 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, Context.getPointerDiffType() }; 5440 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType(); 5441 QualType ResultTy = Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType); 5442 5443 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t) 5444 AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 5445 } 5446 5447 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 5448 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(), 5449 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end(); 5450 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 5451 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { Context.getPointerDiffType(), *Ptr }; 5452 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType(); 5453 QualType ResultTy = Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType); 5454 5455 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*) 5456 AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 5457 } 5458 break; 5459 5460 case OO_ArrowStar: 5461 // C++ [over.built]p11: 5462 // For every quintuple (C1, C2, T, CV1, CV2), where C2 is a class type, 5463 // C1 is the same type as C2 or is a derived class of C2, T is an object 5464 // type or a function type, and CV1 and CV2 are cv-qualifier-seqs, 5465 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form 5466 // 5467 // CV12 T& operator->*(CV1 C1*, CV2 T C2::*); 5468 // 5469 // where CV12 is the union of CV1 and CV2. 5470 { 5471 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 5472 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 5473 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 5474 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 5475 QualType C1Ty = (*Ptr); 5476 QualType C1; 5477 QualifierCollector Q1; 5478 C1 = QualType(Q1.strip(C1Ty->getPointeeType()), 0); 5479 if (!isa<RecordType>(C1)) 5480 continue; 5481 // heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set. 5482 // Add volatile/restrict version only if there are conversions to a 5483 // volatile/restrict type. 5484 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && Q1.hasVolatile()) 5485 continue; 5486 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && Q1.hasRestrict()) 5487 continue; 5488 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 5489 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_begin(), 5490 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_end(); 5491 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) { 5492 const MemberPointerType *mptr = cast<MemberPointerType>(*MemPtr); 5493 QualType C2 = QualType(mptr->getClass(), 0); 5494 C2 = C2.getUnqualifiedType(); 5495 if (C1 != C2 && !IsDerivedFrom(C1, C2)) 5496 break; 5497 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *MemPtr }; 5498 // build CV12 T& 5499 QualType T = mptr->getPointeeType(); 5500 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && 5501 T.isVolatileQualified()) 5502 continue; 5503 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && 5504 T.isRestrictQualified()) 5505 continue; 5506 T = Q1.apply(Context, T); 5507 QualType ResultTy = Context.getLValueReferenceType(T); 5508 AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 5509 } 5510 } 5511 } 5512 break; 5513 5514 case OO_Conditional: 5515 // Note that we don't consider the first argument, since it has been 5516 // contextually converted to bool long ago. The candidates below are 5517 // therefore added as binary. 5518 // 5519 // C++ [over.built]p25: 5520 // For every type T, where T is a pointer, pointer-to-member, or scoped 5521 // enumeration type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 5522 // 5523 // T operator?(bool, T, T); 5524 // 5525 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 5526 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 5527 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(), 5528 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end(); 5529 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 5530 if (!AddedTypes.insert(Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr))) 5531 continue; 5532 5533 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr }; 5534 AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 5535 } 5536 5537 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 5538 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(), 5539 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end(); 5540 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) { 5541 if (!AddedTypes.insert(Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr))) 5542 continue; 5543 5544 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr }; 5545 AddBuiltinCandidate(*MemPtr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 5546 } 5547 5548 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x) { 5549 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 5550 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(), 5551 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end(); 5552 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) { 5553 if (!(*Enum)->getAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->isScoped()) 5554 continue; 5555 5556 if (!AddedTypes.insert(Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum))) 5557 continue; 5558 5559 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum }; 5560 AddBuiltinCandidate(*Enum, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 5561 } 5562 } 5563 } 5564 goto Conditional; 5565 } 5566} 5567 5568/// \brief Add function candidates found via argument-dependent lookup 5569/// to the set of overloading candidates. 5570/// 5571/// This routine performs argument-dependent name lookup based on the 5572/// given function name (which may also be an operator name) and adds 5573/// all of the overload candidates found by ADL to the overload 5574/// candidate set (C++ [basic.lookup.argdep]). 5575void 5576Sema::AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(DeclarationName Name, 5577 bool Operator, 5578 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs, 5579 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 5580 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 5581 bool PartialOverloading) { 5582 ADLResult Fns; 5583 5584 // FIXME: This approach for uniquing ADL results (and removing 5585 // redundant candidates from the set) relies on pointer-equality, 5586 // which means we need to key off the canonical decl. However, 5587 // always going back to the canonical decl might not get us the 5588 // right set of default arguments. What default arguments are 5589 // we supposed to consider on ADL candidates, anyway? 5590 5591 // FIXME: Pass in the explicit template arguments? 5592 ArgumentDependentLookup(Name, Operator, Args, NumArgs, Fns); 5593 5594 // Erase all of the candidates we already knew about. 5595 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(), 5596 CandEnd = CandidateSet.end(); 5597 Cand != CandEnd; ++Cand) 5598 if (Cand->Function) { 5599 Fns.erase(Cand->Function); 5600 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Cand->Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) 5601 Fns.erase(FunTmpl); 5602 } 5603 5604 // For each of the ADL candidates we found, add it to the overload 5605 // set. 5606 for (ADLResult::iterator I = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); I != E; ++I) { 5607 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(*I, AS_none); 5608 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*I)) { 5609 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) 5610 continue; 5611 5612 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, FoundDecl, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet, 5613 false, PartialOverloading); 5614 } else 5615 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*I), 5616 FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, 5617 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet); 5618 } 5619} 5620 5621/// isBetterOverloadCandidate - Determines whether the first overload 5622/// candidate is a better candidate than the second (C++ 13.3.3p1). 5623bool 5624isBetterOverloadCandidate(Sema &S, 5625 const OverloadCandidate &Cand1, 5626 const OverloadCandidate &Cand2, 5627 SourceLocation Loc, 5628 bool UserDefinedConversion) { 5629 // Define viable functions to be better candidates than non-viable 5630 // functions. 5631 if (!Cand2.Viable) 5632 return Cand1.Viable; 5633 else if (!Cand1.Viable) 5634 return false; 5635 5636 // C++ [over.match.best]p1: 5637 // 5638 // -- if F is a static member function, ICS1(F) is defined such 5639 // that ICS1(F) is neither better nor worse than ICS1(G) for 5640 // any function G, and, symmetrically, ICS1(G) is neither 5641 // better nor worse than ICS1(F). 5642 unsigned StartArg = 0; 5643 if (Cand1.IgnoreObjectArgument || Cand2.IgnoreObjectArgument) 5644 StartArg = 1; 5645 5646 // C++ [over.match.best]p1: 5647 // A viable function F1 is defined to be a better function than another 5648 // viable function F2 if for all arguments i, ICSi(F1) is not a worse 5649 // conversion sequence than ICSi(F2), and then... 5650 unsigned NumArgs = Cand1.Conversions.size(); 5651 assert(Cand2.Conversions.size() == NumArgs && "Overload candidate mismatch"); 5652 bool HasBetterConversion = false; 5653 for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 5654 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, 5655 Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx], 5656 Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx])) { 5657 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better: 5658 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence. 5659 HasBetterConversion = true; 5660 break; 5661 5662 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse: 5663 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2. 5664 return false; 5665 5666 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable: 5667 // Do nothing. 5668 break; 5669 } 5670 } 5671 5672 // -- for some argument j, ICSj(F1) is a better conversion sequence than 5673 // ICSj(F2), or, if not that, 5674 if (HasBetterConversion) 5675 return true; 5676 5677 // - F1 is a non-template function and F2 is a function template 5678 // specialization, or, if not that, 5679 if ((!Cand1.Function || !Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) && 5680 Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) 5681 return true; 5682 5683 // -- F1 and F2 are function template specializations, and the function 5684 // template for F1 is more specialized than the template for F2 5685 // according to the partial ordering rules described in 14.5.5.2, or, 5686 // if not that, 5687 if (Cand1.Function && Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate() && 5688 Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) 5689 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *BetterTemplate 5690 = S.getMoreSpecializedTemplate(Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(), 5691 Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(), 5692 Loc, 5693 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function)? TPOC_Conversion 5694 : TPOC_Call)) 5695 return BetterTemplate == Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(); 5696 5697 // -- the context is an initialization by user-defined conversion 5698 // (see 8.5, 13.3.1.5) and the standard conversion sequence 5699 // from the return type of F1 to the destination type (i.e., 5700 // the type of the entity being initialized) is a better 5701 // conversion sequence than the standard conversion sequence 5702 // from the return type of F2 to the destination type. 5703 if (UserDefinedConversion && Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function && 5704 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) && 5705 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand2.Function)) { 5706 switch (CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, 5707 Cand1.FinalConversion, 5708 Cand2.FinalConversion)) { 5709 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better: 5710 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence. 5711 return true; 5712 5713 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse: 5714 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2. 5715 return false; 5716 5717 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable: 5718 // Do nothing 5719 break; 5720 } 5721 } 5722 5723 return false; 5724} 5725 5726/// \brief Computes the best viable function (C++ 13.3.3) 5727/// within an overload candidate set. 5728/// 5729/// \param CandidateSet the set of candidate functions. 5730/// 5731/// \param Loc the location of the function name (or operator symbol) for 5732/// which overload resolution occurs. 5733/// 5734/// \param Best f overload resolution was successful or found a deleted 5735/// function, Best points to the candidate function found. 5736/// 5737/// \returns The result of overload resolution. 5738OverloadingResult 5739OverloadCandidateSet::BestViableFunction(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 5740 iterator &Best, 5741 bool UserDefinedConversion) { 5742 // Find the best viable function. 5743 Best = end(); 5744 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) { 5745 if (Cand->Viable) 5746 if (Best == end() || isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Cand, *Best, Loc, 5747 UserDefinedConversion)) 5748 Best = Cand; 5749 } 5750 5751 // If we didn't find any viable functions, abort. 5752 if (Best == end()) 5753 return OR_No_Viable_Function; 5754 5755 // Make sure that this function is better than every other viable 5756 // function. If not, we have an ambiguity. 5757 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) { 5758 if (Cand->Viable && 5759 Cand != Best && 5760 !isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Best, *Cand, Loc, 5761 UserDefinedConversion)) { 5762 Best = end(); 5763 return OR_Ambiguous; 5764 } 5765 } 5766 5767 // Best is the best viable function. 5768 if (Best->Function && 5769 (Best->Function->isDeleted() || 5770 Best->Function->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>())) 5771 return OR_Deleted; 5772 5773 // C++ [basic.def.odr]p2: 5774 // An overloaded function is used if it is selected by overload resolution 5775 // when referred to from a potentially-evaluated expression. [Note: this 5776 // covers calls to named functions (5.2.2), operator overloading 5777 // (clause 13), user-defined conversions (12.3.2), allocation function for 5778 // placement new (5.3.4), as well as non-default initialization (8.5). 5779 if (Best->Function) 5780 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Best->Function); 5781 5782 return OR_Success; 5783} 5784 5785namespace { 5786 5787enum OverloadCandidateKind { 5788 oc_function, 5789 oc_method, 5790 oc_constructor, 5791 oc_function_template, 5792 oc_method_template, 5793 oc_constructor_template, 5794 oc_implicit_default_constructor, 5795 oc_implicit_copy_constructor, 5796 oc_implicit_copy_assignment 5797}; 5798 5799OverloadCandidateKind ClassifyOverloadCandidate(Sema &S, 5800 FunctionDecl *Fn, 5801 std::string &Description) { 5802 bool isTemplate = false; 5803 5804 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Fn->getPrimaryTemplate()) { 5805 isTemplate = true; 5806 Description = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText( 5807 FunTmpl->getTemplateParameters(), *Fn->getTemplateSpecializationArgs()); 5808 } 5809 5810 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) { 5811 if (!Ctor->isImplicit()) 5812 return isTemplate ? oc_constructor_template : oc_constructor; 5813 5814 return Ctor->isCopyConstructor() ? oc_implicit_copy_constructor 5815 : oc_implicit_default_constructor; 5816 } 5817 5818 if (CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) { 5819 // This actually gets spelled 'candidate function' for now, but 5820 // it doesn't hurt to split it out. 5821 if (!Meth->isImplicit()) 5822 return isTemplate ? oc_method_template : oc_method; 5823 5824 assert(Meth->isCopyAssignmentOperator() 5825 && "implicit method is not copy assignment operator?"); 5826 return oc_implicit_copy_assignment; 5827 } 5828 5829 return isTemplate ? oc_function_template : oc_function; 5830} 5831 5832} // end anonymous namespace 5833 5834// Notes the location of an overload candidate. 5835void Sema::NoteOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Fn) { 5836 std::string FnDesc; 5837 OverloadCandidateKind K = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(*this, Fn, FnDesc); 5838 Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate) 5839 << (unsigned) K << FnDesc; 5840} 5841 5842/// Diagnoses an ambiguous conversion. The partial diagnostic is the 5843/// "lead" diagnostic; it will be given two arguments, the source and 5844/// target types of the conversion. 5845void ImplicitConversionSequence::DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion( 5846 Sema &S, 5847 SourceLocation CaretLoc, 5848 const PartialDiagnostic &PDiag) const { 5849 S.Diag(CaretLoc, PDiag) 5850 << Ambiguous.getFromType() << Ambiguous.getToType(); 5851 for (AmbiguousConversionSequence::const_iterator 5852 I = Ambiguous.begin(), E = Ambiguous.end(); I != E; ++I) { 5853 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(*I); 5854 } 5855} 5856 5857namespace { 5858 5859void DiagnoseBadConversion(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, unsigned I) { 5860 const ImplicitConversionSequence &Conv = Cand->Conversions[I]; 5861 assert(Conv.isBad()); 5862 assert(Cand->Function && "for now, candidate must be a function"); 5863 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; 5864 5865 // There's a conversion slot for the object argument if this is a 5866 // non-constructor method. Note that 'I' corresponds the 5867 // conversion-slot index. 5868 bool isObjectArgument = false; 5869 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn) && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) { 5870 if (I == 0) 5871 isObjectArgument = true; 5872 else 5873 I--; 5874 } 5875 5876 std::string FnDesc; 5877 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc); 5878 5879 Expr *FromExpr = Conv.Bad.FromExpr; 5880 QualType FromTy = Conv.Bad.getFromType(); 5881 QualType ToTy = Conv.Bad.getToType(); 5882 5883 if (FromTy == S.Context.OverloadTy) { 5884 assert(FromExpr && "overload set argument came from implicit argument?"); 5885 Expr *E = FromExpr->IgnoreParens(); 5886 if (isa<UnaryOperator>(E)) 5887 E = cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens(); 5888 DeclarationName Name = cast<OverloadExpr>(E)->getName(); 5889 5890 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_overload) 5891 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 5892 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 5893 << ToTy << Name << I+1; 5894 return; 5895 } 5896 5897 // Do some hand-waving analysis to see if the non-viability is due 5898 // to a qualifier mismatch. 5899 CanQualType CFromTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromTy); 5900 CanQualType CToTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToTy); 5901 if (CanQual<ReferenceType> RT = CToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 5902 CToTy = RT->getPointeeType(); 5903 else { 5904 // TODO: detect and diagnose the full richness of const mismatches. 5905 if (CanQual<PointerType> FromPT = CFromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) 5906 if (CanQual<PointerType> ToPT = CToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) 5907 CFromTy = FromPT->getPointeeType(), CToTy = ToPT->getPointeeType(); 5908 } 5909 5910 if (CToTy.getUnqualifiedType() == CFromTy.getUnqualifiedType() && 5911 !CToTy.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(CFromTy)) { 5912 // It is dumb that we have to do this here. 5913 while (isa<ArrayType>(CFromTy)) 5914 CFromTy = CFromTy->getAs<ArrayType>()->getElementType(); 5915 while (isa<ArrayType>(CToTy)) 5916 CToTy = CFromTy->getAs<ArrayType>()->getElementType(); 5917 5918 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers(); 5919 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers(); 5920 5921 if (FromQs.getAddressSpace() != ToQs.getAddressSpace()) { 5922 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace) 5923 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 5924 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 5925 << FromTy 5926 << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace() 5927 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1; 5928 return; 5929 } 5930 5931 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers(); 5932 assert(CVR && "unexpected qualifiers mismatch"); 5933 5934 if (isObjectArgument) { 5935 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr_this) 5936 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 5937 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 5938 << FromTy << (CVR - 1); 5939 } else { 5940 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr) 5941 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 5942 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 5943 << FromTy << (CVR - 1) << I+1; 5944 } 5945 return; 5946 } 5947 5948 // Diagnose references or pointers to incomplete types differently, 5949 // since it's far from impossible that the incompleteness triggered 5950 // the failure. 5951 QualType TempFromTy = FromTy.getNonReferenceType(); 5952 if (const PointerType *PTy = TempFromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) 5953 TempFromTy = PTy->getPointeeType(); 5954 if (TempFromTy->isIncompleteType()) { 5955 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv_incomplete) 5956 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 5957 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 5958 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1; 5959 return; 5960 } 5961 5962 // Diagnose base -> derived pointer conversions. 5963 unsigned BaseToDerivedConversion = 0; 5964 if (const PointerType *FromPtrTy = FromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) { 5965 if (const PointerType *ToPtrTy = ToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) { 5966 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs( 5967 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) && 5968 !FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() && 5969 !ToPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() && 5970 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPtrTy->getPointeeType(), 5971 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType())) 5972 BaseToDerivedConversion = 1; 5973 } 5974 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrTy 5975 = FromTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 5976 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrTy 5977 = ToTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) 5978 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *FromIface = FromPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl()) 5979 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ToIface = ToPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl()) 5980 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs( 5981 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) && 5982 FromIface->isSuperClassOf(ToIface)) 5983 BaseToDerivedConversion = 2; 5984 } else if (const ReferenceType *ToRefTy = ToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) { 5985 if (ToRefTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTy) && 5986 !FromTy->isIncompleteType() && 5987 !ToRefTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() && 5988 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToRefTy->getPointeeType(), FromTy)) 5989 BaseToDerivedConversion = 3; 5990 } 5991 5992 if (BaseToDerivedConversion) { 5993 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), 5994 diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_base_to_derived_conv) 5995 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 5996 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 5997 << (BaseToDerivedConversion - 1) 5998 << FromTy << ToTy << I+1; 5999 return; 6000 } 6001 6002 // TODO: specialize more based on the kind of mismatch 6003 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv) 6004 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 6005 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 6006 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1; 6007} 6008 6009void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 6010 unsigned NumFormalArgs) { 6011 // TODO: treat calls to a missing default constructor as a special case 6012 6013 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; 6014 const FunctionProtoType *FnTy = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 6015 6016 unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments(); 6017 6018 // at least / at most / exactly 6019 // FIXME: variadic templates "at most" should account for parameter packs 6020 unsigned mode, modeCount; 6021 if (NumFormalArgs < MinParams) { 6022 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) || 6023 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction && 6024 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments)); 6025 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs() || FnTy->isVariadic()) 6026 mode = 0; // "at least" 6027 else 6028 mode = 2; // "exactly" 6029 modeCount = MinParams; 6030 } else { 6031 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments) || 6032 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction && 6033 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments)); 6034 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs()) 6035 mode = 1; // "at most" 6036 else 6037 mode = 2; // "exactly" 6038 modeCount = FnTy->getNumArgs(); 6039 } 6040 6041 std::string Description; 6042 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, Description); 6043 6044 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity) 6045 << (unsigned) FnKind << (Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() != 0) << mode 6046 << modeCount << NumFormalArgs; 6047} 6048 6049/// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction. 6050void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 6051 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) { 6052 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; // pattern 6053 6054 TemplateParameter Param = Cand->DeductionFailure.getTemplateParameter(); 6055 NamedDecl *ParamD; 6056 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl*>()) || 6057 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl*>()) || 6058 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl*>()); 6059 switch (Cand->DeductionFailure.Result) { 6060 case Sema::TDK_Success: 6061 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction"); 6062 6063 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: { 6064 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result"); 6065 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction) 6066 << ParamD->getDeclName(); 6067 return; 6068 } 6069 6070 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: { 6071 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for bad qualifiers deduction result"); 6072 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TParam = cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD); 6073 6074 QualType Param = Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getAsType(); 6075 6076 // Param will have been canonicalized, but it should just be a 6077 // qualified version of ParamD, so move the qualifiers to that. 6078 QualifierCollector Qs; 6079 Qs.strip(Param); 6080 QualType NonCanonParam = Qs.apply(S.Context, TParam->getTypeForDecl()); 6081 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(Param, NonCanonParam)); 6082 6083 // Arg has also been canonicalized, but there's nothing we can do 6084 // about that. It also doesn't matter as much, because it won't 6085 // have any template parameters in it (because deduction isn't 6086 // done on dependent types). 6087 QualType Arg = Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getAsType(); 6088 6089 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_underqualified) 6090 << ParamD->getDeclName() << Arg << NonCanonParam; 6091 return; 6092 } 6093 6094 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: { 6095 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for inconsistent deduction result"); 6096 int which = 0; 6097 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD)) 6098 which = 0; 6099 else if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)) 6100 which = 1; 6101 else { 6102 which = 2; 6103 } 6104 6105 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction) 6106 << which << ParamD->getDeclName() 6107 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg() 6108 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg(); 6109 return; 6110 } 6111 6112 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 6113 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for invalid explicit arguments"); 6114 if (ParamD->getDeclName()) 6115 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), 6116 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_named) 6117 << ParamD->getDeclName(); 6118 else { 6119 int index = 0; 6120 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD)) 6121 index = TTP->getIndex(); 6122 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP 6123 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)) 6124 index = NTTP->getIndex(); 6125 else 6126 index = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)->getIndex(); 6127 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), 6128 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_unnamed) 6129 << (index + 1); 6130 } 6131 return; 6132 6133 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 6134 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 6135 DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs); 6136 return; 6137 6138 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 6139 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_instantiation_depth); 6140 return; 6141 6142 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: { 6143 std::string ArgString; 6144 if (TemplateArgumentList *Args 6145 = Cand->DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList()) 6146 ArgString = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText( 6147 Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()->getTemplateParameters(), 6148 *Args); 6149 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_substitution_failure) 6150 << ArgString; 6151 return; 6152 } 6153 6154 // TODO: diagnose these individually, then kill off 6155 // note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction, which is uselessly vague. 6156 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 6157 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution: 6158 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction); 6159 return; 6160 } 6161} 6162 6163/// Generates a 'note' diagnostic for an overload candidate. We've 6164/// already generated a primary error at the call site. 6165/// 6166/// It really does need to be a single diagnostic with its caret 6167/// pointed at the candidate declaration. Yes, this creates some 6168/// major challenges of technical writing. Yes, this makes pointing 6169/// out problems with specific arguments quite awkward. It's still 6170/// better than generating twenty screens of text for every failed 6171/// overload. 6172/// 6173/// It would be great to be able to express per-candidate problems 6174/// more richly for those diagnostic clients that cared, but we'd 6175/// still have to be just as careful with the default diagnostics. 6176void NoteFunctionCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 6177 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) { 6178 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; 6179 6180 // Note deleted candidates, but only if they're viable. 6181 if (Cand->Viable && (Fn->isDeleted() || Fn->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>())) { 6182 std::string FnDesc; 6183 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc); 6184 6185 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deleted) 6186 << FnKind << FnDesc << Fn->isDeleted(); 6187 return; 6188 } 6189 6190 // We don't really have anything else to say about viable candidates. 6191 if (Cand->Viable) { 6192 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn); 6193 return; 6194 } 6195 6196 switch (Cand->FailureKind) { 6197 case ovl_fail_too_many_arguments: 6198 case ovl_fail_too_few_arguments: 6199 return DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs); 6200 6201 case ovl_fail_bad_deduction: 6202 return DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand, Args, NumArgs); 6203 6204 case ovl_fail_trivial_conversion: 6205 case ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion: 6206 case ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact: 6207 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn); 6208 6209 case ovl_fail_bad_conversion: { 6210 unsigned I = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0); 6211 for (unsigned N = Cand->Conversions.size(); I != N; ++I) 6212 if (Cand->Conversions[I].isBad()) 6213 return DiagnoseBadConversion(S, Cand, I); 6214 6215 // FIXME: this currently happens when we're called from SemaInit 6216 // when user-conversion overload fails. Figure out how to handle 6217 // those conditions and diagnose them well. 6218 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn); 6219 } 6220 } 6221} 6222 6223void NoteSurrogateCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 6224 // Desugar the type of the surrogate down to a function type, 6225 // retaining as many typedefs as possible while still showing 6226 // the function type (and, therefore, its parameter types). 6227 QualType FnType = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType(); 6228 bool isLValueReference = false; 6229 bool isRValueReference = false; 6230 bool isPointer = false; 6231 if (const LValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef = 6232 FnType->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) { 6233 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType(); 6234 isLValueReference = true; 6235 } else if (const RValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef = 6236 FnType->getAs<RValueReferenceType>()) { 6237 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType(); 6238 isRValueReference = true; 6239 } 6240 if (const PointerType *FnTypePtr = FnType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 6241 FnType = FnTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 6242 isPointer = true; 6243 } 6244 // Desugar down to a function type. 6245 FnType = QualType(FnType->getAs<FunctionType>(), 0); 6246 // Reconstruct the pointer/reference as appropriate. 6247 if (isPointer) FnType = S.Context.getPointerType(FnType); 6248 if (isRValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(FnType); 6249 if (isLValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(FnType); 6250 6251 S.Diag(Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_surrogate_cand) 6252 << FnType; 6253} 6254 6255void NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(Sema &S, 6256 const char *Opc, 6257 SourceLocation OpLoc, 6258 OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 6259 assert(Cand->Conversions.size() <= 2 && "builtin operator is not binary"); 6260 std::string TypeStr("operator"); 6261 TypeStr += Opc; 6262 TypeStr += "("; 6263 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0].getAsString(); 6264 if (Cand->Conversions.size() == 1) { 6265 TypeStr += ")"; 6266 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_unary_candidate) << TypeStr; 6267 } else { 6268 TypeStr += ", "; 6269 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1].getAsString(); 6270 TypeStr += ")"; 6271 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_binary_candidate) << TypeStr; 6272 } 6273} 6274 6275void NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 6276 OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 6277 unsigned NoOperands = Cand->Conversions.size(); 6278 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NoOperands; ++ArgIdx) { 6279 const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS = Cand->Conversions[ArgIdx]; 6280 if (ICS.isBad()) break; // all meaningless after first invalid 6281 if (!ICS.isAmbiguous()) continue; 6282 6283 ICS.DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(S, OpLoc, 6284 S.PDiag(diag::note_ambiguous_type_conversion)); 6285 } 6286} 6287 6288SourceLocation GetLocationForCandidate(const OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 6289 if (Cand->Function) 6290 return Cand->Function->getLocation(); 6291 if (Cand->IsSurrogate) 6292 return Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(); 6293 return SourceLocation(); 6294} 6295 6296struct CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay { 6297 Sema &S; 6298 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S) : S(S) {} 6299 6300 bool operator()(const OverloadCandidate *L, 6301 const OverloadCandidate *R) { 6302 // Fast-path this check. 6303 if (L == R) return false; 6304 6305 // Order first by viability. 6306 if (L->Viable) { 6307 if (!R->Viable) return true; 6308 6309 // TODO: introduce a tri-valued comparison for overload 6310 // candidates. Would be more worthwhile if we had a sort 6311 // that could exploit it. 6312 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *L, *R, SourceLocation())) return true; 6313 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *R, *L, SourceLocation())) return false; 6314 } else if (R->Viable) 6315 return false; 6316 6317 assert(L->Viable == R->Viable); 6318 6319 // Criteria by which we can sort non-viable candidates: 6320 if (!L->Viable) { 6321 // 1. Arity mismatches come after other candidates. 6322 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments || 6323 L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) 6324 return false; 6325 if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments || 6326 R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) 6327 return true; 6328 6329 // 2. Bad conversions come first and are ordered by the number 6330 // of bad conversions and quality of good conversions. 6331 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) { 6332 if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) 6333 return true; 6334 6335 // If there's any ordering between the defined conversions... 6336 // FIXME: this might not be transitive. 6337 assert(L->Conversions.size() == R->Conversions.size()); 6338 6339 int leftBetter = 0; 6340 unsigned I = (L->IgnoreObjectArgument || R->IgnoreObjectArgument); 6341 for (unsigned E = L->Conversions.size(); I != E; ++I) { 6342 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, 6343 L->Conversions[I], 6344 R->Conversions[I])) { 6345 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better: 6346 leftBetter++; 6347 break; 6348 6349 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse: 6350 leftBetter--; 6351 break; 6352 6353 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable: 6354 break; 6355 } 6356 } 6357 if (leftBetter > 0) return true; 6358 if (leftBetter < 0) return false; 6359 6360 } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) 6361 return false; 6362 6363 // TODO: others? 6364 } 6365 6366 // Sort everything else by location. 6367 SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L); 6368 SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R); 6369 6370 // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end. 6371 if (LLoc.isInvalid()) return false; 6372 if (RLoc.isInvalid()) return true; 6373 6374 return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc); 6375 } 6376}; 6377 6378/// CompleteNonViableCandidate - Normally, overload resolution only 6379/// computes up to the first 6380void CompleteNonViableCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 6381 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) { 6382 assert(!Cand->Viable); 6383 6384 // Don't do anything on failures other than bad conversion. 6385 if (Cand->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) return; 6386 6387 // Skip forward to the first bad conversion. 6388 unsigned ConvIdx = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0); 6389 unsigned ConvCount = Cand->Conversions.size(); 6390 while (true) { 6391 assert(ConvIdx != ConvCount && "no bad conversion in candidate"); 6392 ConvIdx++; 6393 if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx - 1].isBad()) 6394 break; 6395 } 6396 6397 if (ConvIdx == ConvCount) 6398 return; 6399 6400 assert(!Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized() && 6401 "remaining conversion is initialized?"); 6402 6403 // FIXME: this should probably be preserved from the overload 6404 // operation somehow. 6405 bool SuppressUserConversions = false; 6406 6407 const FunctionProtoType* Proto; 6408 unsigned ArgIdx = ConvIdx; 6409 6410 if (Cand->IsSurrogate) { 6411 QualType ConvType 6412 = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 6413 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>()) 6414 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType(); 6415 Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 6416 ArgIdx--; 6417 } else if (Cand->Function) { 6418 Proto = Cand->Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 6419 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Cand->Function) && 6420 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand->Function)) 6421 ArgIdx--; 6422 } else { 6423 // Builtin binary operator with a bad first conversion. 6424 assert(ConvCount <= 3); 6425 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx) 6426 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx] 6427 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ConvIdx], 6428 Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ConvIdx], 6429 SuppressUserConversions, 6430 /*InOverloadResolution*/ true); 6431 return; 6432 } 6433 6434 // Fill in the rest of the conversions. 6435 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs(); 6436 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx, ++ArgIdx) { 6437 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) 6438 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx] 6439 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ArgIdx], Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx), 6440 SuppressUserConversions, 6441 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true); 6442 else 6443 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis(); 6444 } 6445} 6446 6447} // end anonymous namespace 6448 6449/// PrintOverloadCandidates - When overload resolution fails, prints 6450/// diagnostic messages containing the candidates in the candidate 6451/// set. 6452void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S, 6453 OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD, 6454 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs, 6455 const char *Opc, 6456 SourceLocation OpLoc) { 6457 // Sort the candidates by viability and position. Sorting directly would 6458 // be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers and sort those. 6459 llvm::SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 32> Cands; 6460 if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) Cands.reserve(size()); 6461 for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) { 6462 if (Cand->Viable) 6463 Cands.push_back(Cand); 6464 else if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) { 6465 CompleteNonViableCandidate(S, Cand, Args, NumArgs); 6466 if (Cand->Function || Cand->IsSurrogate) 6467 Cands.push_back(Cand); 6468 // Otherwise, this a non-viable builtin candidate. We do not, in general, 6469 // want to list every possible builtin candidate. 6470 } 6471 } 6472 6473 std::sort(Cands.begin(), Cands.end(), 6474 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(S)); 6475 6476 bool ReportedAmbiguousConversions = false; 6477 6478 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<OverloadCandidate*>::iterator I, E; 6479 const Diagnostic::OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads(); 6480 unsigned CandsShown = 0; 6481 for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) { 6482 OverloadCandidate *Cand = *I; 6483 6484 // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidate functions we'll spam 6485 // the user with. FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the 6486 // candidate list. 6487 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Diagnostic::Ovl_Best) { 6488 break; 6489 } 6490 ++CandsShown; 6491 6492 if (Cand->Function) 6493 NoteFunctionCandidate(S, Cand, Args, NumArgs); 6494 else if (Cand->IsSurrogate) 6495 NoteSurrogateCandidate(S, Cand); 6496 else { 6497 assert(Cand->Viable && 6498 "Non-viable built-in candidates are not added to Cands."); 6499 // Generally we only see ambiguities including viable builtin 6500 // operators if overload resolution got screwed up by an 6501 // ambiguous user-defined conversion. 6502 // 6503 // FIXME: It's quite possible for different conversions to see 6504 // different ambiguities, though. 6505 if (!ReportedAmbiguousConversions) { 6506 NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(S, OpLoc, Cand); 6507 ReportedAmbiguousConversions = true; 6508 } 6509 6510 // If this is a viable builtin, print it. 6511 NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(S, Opc, OpLoc, Cand); 6512 } 6513 } 6514 6515 if (I != E) 6516 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I); 6517} 6518 6519static bool CheckUnresolvedAccess(Sema &S, OverloadExpr *E, DeclAccessPair D) { 6520 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) 6521 return S.CheckUnresolvedLookupAccess(cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E), D); 6522 6523 return S.CheckUnresolvedMemberAccess(cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(E), D); 6524} 6525 6526/// ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction - Try to resolve the address of 6527/// an overloaded function (C++ [over.over]), where @p From is an 6528/// expression with overloaded function type and @p ToType is the type 6529/// we're trying to resolve to. For example: 6530/// 6531/// @code 6532/// int f(double); 6533/// int f(int); 6534/// 6535/// int (*pfd)(double) = f; // selects f(double) 6536/// @endcode 6537/// 6538/// This routine returns the resulting FunctionDecl if it could be 6539/// resolved, and NULL otherwise. When @p Complain is true, this 6540/// routine will emit diagnostics if there is an error. 6541FunctionDecl * 6542Sema::ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 6543 bool Complain, 6544 DeclAccessPair &FoundResult) { 6545 QualType FunctionType = ToType; 6546 bool IsMember = false; 6547 if (const PointerType *ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) 6548 FunctionType = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 6549 else if (const ReferenceType *ToTypeRef = ToType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 6550 FunctionType = ToTypeRef->getPointeeType(); 6551 else if (const MemberPointerType *MemTypePtr = 6552 ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) { 6553 FunctionType = MemTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 6554 IsMember = true; 6555 } 6556 6557 // C++ [over.over]p1: 6558 // [...] [Note: any redundant set of parentheses surrounding the 6559 // overloaded function name is ignored (5.1). ] 6560 // C++ [over.over]p1: 6561 // [...] The overloaded function name can be preceded by the & 6562 // operator. 6563 // However, remember whether the expression has member-pointer form: 6564 // C++ [expr.unary.op]p4: 6565 // A pointer to member is only formed when an explicit & is used 6566 // and its operand is a qualified-id not enclosed in 6567 // parentheses. 6568 OverloadExpr::FindResult Ovl = OverloadExpr::find(From); 6569 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = Ovl.Expression; 6570 6571 // We expect a pointer or reference to function, or a function pointer. 6572 FunctionType = Context.getCanonicalType(FunctionType).getUnqualifiedType(); 6573 if (!FunctionType->isFunctionType()) { 6574 if (Complain) 6575 Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_not_func_ptrref) 6576 << OvlExpr->getName() << ToType; 6577 6578 return 0; 6579 } 6580 6581 // If the overload expression doesn't have the form of a pointer to 6582 // member, don't try to convert it to a pointer-to-member type. 6583 if (IsMember && !Ovl.HasFormOfMemberPointer) { 6584 if (!Complain) return 0; 6585 6586 // TODO: Should we condition this on whether any functions might 6587 // have matched, or is it more appropriate to do that in callers? 6588 // TODO: a fixit wouldn't hurt. 6589 Diag(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_qualifier) 6590 << ToType << OvlExpr->getSourceRange(); 6591 return 0; 6592 } 6593 6594 TemplateArgumentListInfo ETABuffer, *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0; 6595 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 6596 OvlExpr->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(ETABuffer); 6597 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &ETABuffer; 6598 } 6599 6600 assert(From->getType() == Context.OverloadTy); 6601 6602 // Look through all of the overloaded functions, searching for one 6603 // whose type matches exactly. 6604 llvm::SmallVector<std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl*>, 4> Matches; 6605 llvm::SmallVector<FunctionDecl *, 4> NonMatches; 6606 6607 bool FoundNonTemplateFunction = false; 6608 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(), 6609 E = OvlExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) { 6610 // Look through any using declarations to find the underlying function. 6611 NamedDecl *Fn = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl(); 6612 6613 // C++ [over.over]p3: 6614 // Non-member functions and static member functions match 6615 // targets of type "pointer-to-function" or "reference-to-function." 6616 // Nonstatic member functions match targets of 6617 // type "pointer-to-member-function." 6618 // Note that according to DR 247, the containing class does not matter. 6619 6620 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate 6621 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Fn)) { 6622 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method 6623 = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl())) { 6624 // Skip non-static function templates when converting to pointer, and 6625 // static when converting to member pointer. 6626 if (Method->isStatic() == IsMember) 6627 continue; 6628 } else if (IsMember) 6629 continue; 6630 6631 // C++ [over.over]p2: 6632 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is 6633 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the 6634 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single 6635 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of 6636 // overloaded functions considered. 6637 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0; 6638 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, OvlExpr->getNameLoc()); 6639 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result 6640 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ExplicitTemplateArgs, 6641 FunctionType, Specialization, Info)) { 6642 // FIXME: make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics. 6643 (void)Result; 6644 } else { 6645 // Template argument deduction ensures that we have an exact match. 6646 // This function template specicalization works. 6647 Specialization = cast<FunctionDecl>(Specialization->getCanonicalDecl()); 6648 assert(FunctionType 6649 == Context.getCanonicalType(Specialization->getType())); 6650 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(I.getPair(), Specialization)); 6651 } 6652 6653 continue; 6654 } 6655 6656 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) { 6657 // Skip non-static functions when converting to pointer, and static 6658 // when converting to member pointer. 6659 if (Method->isStatic() == IsMember) 6660 continue; 6661 6662 // If we have explicit template arguments, skip non-templates. 6663 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) 6664 continue; 6665 } else if (IsMember) 6666 continue; 6667 6668 if (FunctionDecl *FunDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Fn)) { 6669 QualType ResultTy; 6670 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FunctionType, FunDecl->getType()) || 6671 IsNoReturnConversion(Context, FunDecl->getType(), FunctionType, 6672 ResultTy)) { 6673 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(I.getPair(), 6674 cast<FunctionDecl>(FunDecl->getCanonicalDecl()))); 6675 FoundNonTemplateFunction = true; 6676 } 6677 } 6678 } 6679 6680 // If there were 0 or 1 matches, we're done. 6681 if (Matches.empty()) { 6682 if (Complain) { 6683 Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_viable) 6684 << OvlExpr->getName() << FunctionType; 6685 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(), 6686 E = OvlExpr->decls_end(); 6687 I != E; ++I) 6688 if (FunctionDecl *F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl())) 6689 NoteOverloadCandidate(F); 6690 } 6691 6692 return 0; 6693 } else if (Matches.size() == 1) { 6694 FunctionDecl *Result = Matches[0].second; 6695 FoundResult = Matches[0].first; 6696 MarkDeclarationReferenced(From->getLocStart(), Result); 6697 if (Complain) { 6698 CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(OvlExpr, Matches[0].first); 6699 } 6700 return Result; 6701 } 6702 6703 // C++ [over.over]p4: 6704 // If more than one function is selected, [...] 6705 if (!FoundNonTemplateFunction) { 6706 // [...] and any given function template specialization F1 is 6707 // eliminated if the set contains a second function template 6708 // specialization whose function template is more specialized 6709 // than the function template of F1 according to the partial 6710 // ordering rules of 14.5.5.2. 6711 6712 // The algorithm specified above is quadratic. We instead use a 6713 // two-pass algorithm (similar to the one used to identify the 6714 // best viable function in an overload set) that identifies the 6715 // best function template (if it exists). 6716 6717 UnresolvedSet<4> MatchesCopy; // TODO: avoid! 6718 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Matches.size(); I != E; ++I) 6719 MatchesCopy.addDecl(Matches[I].second, Matches[I].first.getAccess()); 6720 6721 UnresolvedSetIterator Result = 6722 getMostSpecialized(MatchesCopy.begin(), MatchesCopy.end(), 6723 TPOC_Other, From->getLocStart(), 6724 PDiag(), 6725 PDiag(diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous) 6726 << Matches[0].second->getDeclName(), 6727 PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate) 6728 << (unsigned) oc_function_template); 6729 if (Result == MatchesCopy.end()) 6730 return 0; 6731 6732 MarkDeclarationReferenced(From->getLocStart(), *Result); 6733 FoundResult = Matches[Result - MatchesCopy.begin()].first; 6734 if (Complain) 6735 CheckUnresolvedAccess(*this, OvlExpr, FoundResult); 6736 return cast<FunctionDecl>(*Result); 6737 } 6738 6739 // [...] any function template specializations in the set are 6740 // eliminated if the set also contains a non-template function, [...] 6741 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Matches.size(); I != N; ) { 6742 if (Matches[I].second->getPrimaryTemplate() == 0) 6743 ++I; 6744 else { 6745 Matches[I] = Matches[--N]; 6746 Matches.set_size(N); 6747 } 6748 } 6749 6750 // [...] After such eliminations, if any, there shall remain exactly one 6751 // selected function. 6752 if (Matches.size() == 1) { 6753 MarkDeclarationReferenced(From->getLocStart(), Matches[0].second); 6754 FoundResult = Matches[0].first; 6755 if (Complain) 6756 CheckUnresolvedAccess(*this, OvlExpr, Matches[0].first); 6757 return cast<FunctionDecl>(Matches[0].second); 6758 } 6759 6760 // FIXME: We should probably return the same thing that BestViableFunction 6761 // returns (even if we issue the diagnostics here). 6762 if (Complain) { 6763 Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous) 6764 << Matches[0].second->getDeclName(); 6765 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Matches.size(); I != E; ++I) 6766 NoteOverloadCandidate(Matches[I].second); 6767 } 6768 6769 return 0; 6770} 6771 6772/// \brief Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to 6773/// resolve that overloaded function expression down to a single function. 6774/// 6775/// This routine can only resolve template-ids that refer to a single function 6776/// template, where that template-id refers to a single template whose template 6777/// arguments are either provided by the template-id or have defaults, 6778/// as described in C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3. 6779FunctionDecl *Sema::ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(Expr *From) { 6780 // C++ [over.over]p1: 6781 // [...] [Note: any redundant set of parentheses surrounding the 6782 // overloaded function name is ignored (5.1). ] 6783 // C++ [over.over]p1: 6784 // [...] The overloaded function name can be preceded by the & 6785 // operator. 6786 6787 if (From->getType() != Context.OverloadTy) 6788 return 0; 6789 6790 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = OverloadExpr::find(From).Expression; 6791 6792 // If we didn't actually find any template-ids, we're done. 6793 if (!OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) 6794 return 0; 6795 6796 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitTemplateArgs; 6797 OvlExpr->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(ExplicitTemplateArgs); 6798 6799 // Look through all of the overloaded functions, searching for one 6800 // whose type matches exactly. 6801 FunctionDecl *Matched = 0; 6802 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(), 6803 E = OvlExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) { 6804 // C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3: 6805 // [...] In contexts where deduction is done and fails, or in contexts 6806 // where deduction is not done, if a template argument list is 6807 // specified and it, along with any default template arguments, 6808 // identifies a single function template specialization, then the 6809 // template-id is an lvalue for the function template specialization. 6810 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate 6811 = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()); 6812 6813 // C++ [over.over]p2: 6814 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is 6815 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the 6816 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single 6817 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of 6818 // overloaded functions considered. 6819 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0; 6820 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, OvlExpr->getNameLoc()); 6821 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result 6822 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, &ExplicitTemplateArgs, 6823 Specialization, Info)) { 6824 // FIXME: make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics. 6825 (void)Result; 6826 continue; 6827 } 6828 6829 // Multiple matches; we can't resolve to a single declaration. 6830 if (Matched) 6831 return 0; 6832 6833 Matched = Specialization; 6834 } 6835 6836 return Matched; 6837} 6838 6839/// \brief Add a single candidate to the overload set. 6840static void AddOverloadedCallCandidate(Sema &S, 6841 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 6842 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 6843 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs, 6844 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 6845 bool PartialOverloading) { 6846 NamedDecl *Callee = FoundDecl.getDecl(); 6847 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)) 6848 Callee = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)->getTargetDecl(); 6849 6850 if (FunctionDecl *Func = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Callee)) { 6851 assert(!ExplicitTemplateArgs && "Explicit template arguments?"); 6852 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Func, FoundDecl, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet, 6853 false, PartialOverloading); 6854 return; 6855 } 6856 6857 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FuncTemplate 6858 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Callee)) { 6859 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FuncTemplate, FoundDecl, 6860 ExplicitTemplateArgs, 6861 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet); 6862 return; 6863 } 6864 6865 assert(false && "unhandled case in overloaded call candidate"); 6866 6867 // do nothing? 6868} 6869 6870/// \brief Add the overload candidates named by callee and/or found by argument 6871/// dependent lookup to the given overload set. 6872void Sema::AddOverloadedCallCandidates(UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 6873 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs, 6874 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 6875 bool PartialOverloading) { 6876 6877#ifndef NDEBUG 6878 // Verify that ArgumentDependentLookup is consistent with the rules 6879 // in C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3: 6880 // 6881 // Let X be the lookup set produced by unqualified lookup (3.4.1) 6882 // and let Y be the lookup set produced by argument dependent 6883 // lookup (defined as follows). If X contains 6884 // 6885 // -- a declaration of a class member, or 6886 // 6887 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a 6888 // using-declaration, or 6889 // 6890 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function 6891 // template 6892 // 6893 // then Y is empty. 6894 6895 if (ULE->requiresADL()) { 6896 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(), 6897 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) { 6898 assert(!(*I)->getDeclContext()->isRecord()); 6899 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(*I) || 6900 !(*I)->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()); 6901 assert((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate()); 6902 } 6903 } 6904#endif 6905 6906 // It would be nice to avoid this copy. 6907 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer; 6908 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0; 6909 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 6910 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer); 6911 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer; 6912 } 6913 6914 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(), 6915 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) 6916 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(*this, I.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs, 6917 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet, 6918 PartialOverloading); 6919 6920 if (ULE->requiresADL()) 6921 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ULE->getName(), /*Operator*/ false, 6922 Args, NumArgs, 6923 ExplicitTemplateArgs, 6924 CandidateSet, 6925 PartialOverloading); 6926} 6927 6928/// Attempts to recover from a call where no functions were found. 6929/// 6930/// Returns true if new candidates were found. 6931static ExprResult 6932BuildRecoveryCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn, 6933 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 6934 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 6935 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs, 6936 SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 6937 6938 CXXScopeSpec SS; 6939 if (ULE->getQualifier()) { 6940 SS.setScopeRep(ULE->getQualifier()); 6941 SS.setRange(ULE->getQualifierRange()); 6942 } 6943 6944 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer; 6945 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0; 6946 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 6947 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer); 6948 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer; 6949 } 6950 6951 LookupResult R(SemaRef, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(), 6952 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName); 6953 if (SemaRef.DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, Sema::CTC_Expression)) 6954 return ExprError(); 6955 6956 assert(!R.empty() && "lookup results empty despite recovery"); 6957 6958 // Build an implicit member call if appropriate. Just drop the 6959 // casts and such from the call, we don't really care. 6960 ExprResult NewFn = ExprError(); 6961 if ((*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) 6962 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, ExplicitTemplateArgs); 6963 else if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) 6964 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *ExplicitTemplateArgs); 6965 else 6966 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false); 6967 6968 if (NewFn.isInvalid()) 6969 return ExprError(); 6970 6971 // This shouldn't cause an infinite loop because we're giving it 6972 // an expression with non-empty lookup results, which should never 6973 // end up here. 6974 return SemaRef.ActOnCallExpr(/*Scope*/ 0, NewFn.take(), LParenLoc, 6975 MultiExprArg(Args, NumArgs), RParenLoc); 6976} 6977 6978/// ResolveOverloadedCallFn - Given the call expression that calls Fn 6979/// (which eventually refers to the declaration Func) and the call 6980/// arguments Args/NumArgs, attempt to resolve the function call down 6981/// to a specific function. If overload resolution succeeds, returns 6982/// the function declaration produced by overload 6983/// resolution. Otherwise, emits diagnostics, deletes all of the 6984/// arguments and Fn, and returns NULL. 6985ExprResult 6986Sema::BuildOverloadedCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 6987 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 6988 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs, 6989 SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 6990#ifndef NDEBUG 6991 if (ULE->requiresADL()) { 6992 // To do ADL, we must have found an unqualified name. 6993 assert(!ULE->getQualifier() && "qualified name with ADL"); 6994 6995 // We don't perform ADL for implicit declarations of builtins. 6996 // Verify that this was correctly set up. 6997 FunctionDecl *F; 6998 if (ULE->decls_begin() + 1 == ULE->decls_end() && 6999 (F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*ULE->decls_begin())) && 7000 F->getBuiltinID() && F->isImplicit()) 7001 assert(0 && "performing ADL for builtin"); 7002 7003 // We don't perform ADL in C. 7004 assert(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && "ADL enabled in C"); 7005 } 7006#endif 7007 7008 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Fn->getExprLoc()); 7009 7010 // Add the functions denoted by the callee to the set of candidate 7011 // functions, including those from argument-dependent lookup. 7012 AddOverloadedCallCandidates(ULE, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet); 7013 7014 // If we found nothing, try to recover. 7015 // AddRecoveryCallCandidates diagnoses the error itself, so we just 7016 // bailout out if it fails. 7017 if (CandidateSet.empty()) 7018 return BuildRecoveryCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, 7019 RParenLoc); 7020 7021 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 7022 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best)) { 7023 case OR_Success: { 7024 FunctionDecl *FDecl = Best->Function; 7025 CheckUnresolvedLookupAccess(ULE, Best->FoundDecl); 7026 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FDecl? FDecl : Best->FoundDecl.getDecl(), ULE->getNameLoc()); 7027 Fn = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, Best->FoundDecl, FDecl); 7028 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc); 7029 } 7030 7031 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 7032 Diag(Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), 7033 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call) 7034 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange(); 7035 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs); 7036 break; 7037 7038 case OR_Ambiguous: 7039 Diag(Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call) 7040 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange(); 7041 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, NumArgs); 7042 break; 7043 7044 case OR_Deleted: 7045 Diag(Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_call) 7046 << Best->Function->isDeleted() 7047 << ULE->getName() 7048 << Fn->getSourceRange(); 7049 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs); 7050 break; 7051 } 7052 7053 // Overload resolution failed. 7054 return ExprError(); 7055} 7056 7057static bool IsOverloaded(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions) { 7058 return Functions.size() > 1 || 7059 (Functions.size() == 1 && isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*Functions.begin())); 7060} 7061 7062/// \brief Create a unary operation that may resolve to an overloaded 7063/// operator. 7064/// 7065/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '*'). 7066/// 7067/// \param OpcIn The UnaryOperator::Opcode that describes this 7068/// operator. 7069/// 7070/// \param Functions The set of non-member functions that will be 7071/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this 7072/// set based on the context using, e.g., 7073/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This 7074/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added 7075/// by CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(). 7076/// 7077/// \param input The input argument. 7078ExprResult 7079Sema::CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, unsigned OpcIn, 7080 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, 7081 Expr *Input) { 7082 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn); 7083 7084 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc); 7085 assert(Op != OO_None && "Invalid opcode for overloaded unary operator"); 7086 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 7087 // TODO: provide better source location info. 7088 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc); 7089 7090 if (Input->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) 7091 ConvertPropertyForRValue(Input); 7092 7093 Expr *Args[2] = { Input, 0 }; 7094 unsigned NumArgs = 1; 7095 7096 // For post-increment and post-decrement, add the implicit '0' as 7097 // the second argument, so that we know this is a post-increment or 7098 // post-decrement. 7099 if (Opc == UO_PostInc || Opc == UO_PostDec) { 7100 llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false); 7101 Args[1] = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy, 7102 SourceLocation()); 7103 NumArgs = 2; 7104 } 7105 7106 if (Input->isTypeDependent()) { 7107 if (Fns.empty()) 7108 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, 7109 Opc, 7110 Context.DependentTy, 7111 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, 7112 OpLoc)); 7113 7114 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators 7115 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn 7116 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, /*Dependent*/ true, NamingClass, 7117 0, SourceRange(), OpNameInfo, 7118 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns), 7119 Fns.begin(), Fns.end()); 7120 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn, 7121 &Args[0], NumArgs, 7122 Context.DependentTy, 7123 VK_RValue, 7124 OpLoc)); 7125 } 7126 7127 // Build an empty overload set. 7128 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc); 7129 7130 // Add the candidates from the given function set. 7131 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet, false); 7132 7133 // Add operator candidates that are member functions. 7134 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet); 7135 7136 // Add candidates from ADL. 7137 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true, 7138 Args, NumArgs, 7139 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0, 7140 CandidateSet); 7141 7142 // Add builtin operator candidates. 7143 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet); 7144 7145 // Perform overload resolution. 7146 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 7147 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) { 7148 case OR_Success: { 7149 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator. 7150 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function; 7151 7152 if (FnDecl) { 7153 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that 7154 // operator. 7155 7156 // Convert the arguments. 7157 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) { 7158 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], 0, Best->FoundDecl); 7159 7160 if (PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Input, /*Qualifier=*/0, 7161 Best->FoundDecl, Method)) 7162 return ExprError(); 7163 } else { 7164 // Convert the arguments. 7165 ExprResult InputInit 7166 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 7167 Context, 7168 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)), 7169 SourceLocation(), 7170 Input); 7171 if (InputInit.isInvalid()) 7172 return ExprError(); 7173 Input = InputInit.take(); 7174 } 7175 7176 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc); 7177 7178 // Determine the result type. 7179 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType(); 7180 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 7181 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 7182 7183 // Build the actual expression node. 7184 Expr *FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl); 7185 7186 Args[0] = Input; 7187 CallExpr *TheCall = 7188 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr, 7189 Args, NumArgs, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc); 7190 7191 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall, 7192 FnDecl)) 7193 return ExprError(); 7194 7195 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 7196 } else { 7197 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then 7198 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in 7199 // operator node. 7200 if (PerformImplicitConversion(Input, Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0], 7201 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing)) 7202 return ExprError(); 7203 7204 break; 7205 } 7206 } 7207 7208 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 7209 // No viable function; fall through to handling this as a 7210 // built-in operator, which will produce an error message for us. 7211 break; 7212 7213 case OR_Ambiguous: 7214 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary) 7215 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 7216 << Input->getType() 7217 << Input->getSourceRange(); 7218 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, 7219 Args, NumArgs, 7220 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc); 7221 return ExprError(); 7222 7223 case OR_Deleted: 7224 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper) 7225 << Best->Function->isDeleted() 7226 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 7227 << Input->getSourceRange(); 7228 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs); 7229 return ExprError(); 7230 } 7231 7232 // Either we found no viable overloaded operator or we matched a 7233 // built-in operator. In either case, fall through to trying to 7234 // build a built-in operation. 7235 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input); 7236} 7237 7238/// \brief Create a binary operation that may resolve to an overloaded 7239/// operator. 7240/// 7241/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '+'). 7242/// 7243/// \param OpcIn The BinaryOperator::Opcode that describes this 7244/// operator. 7245/// 7246/// \param Functions The set of non-member functions that will be 7247/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this 7248/// set based on the context using, e.g., 7249/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This 7250/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added 7251/// by CreateOverloadedBinOp(). 7252/// 7253/// \param LHS Left-hand argument. 7254/// \param RHS Right-hand argument. 7255ExprResult 7256Sema::CreateOverloadedBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, 7257 unsigned OpcIn, 7258 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, 7259 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) { 7260 Expr *Args[2] = { LHS, RHS }; 7261 LHS=RHS=0; //Please use only Args instead of LHS/RHS couple 7262 7263 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<BinaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn); 7264 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc); 7265 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 7266 7267 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent 7268 // expression. 7269 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) { 7270 if (Fns.empty()) { 7271 // If there are no functions to store, just build a dependent 7272 // BinaryOperator or CompoundAssignment. 7273 if (Opc <= BO_Assign || Opc > BO_OrAssign) 7274 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc, 7275 Context.DependentTy, 7276 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, 7277 OpLoc)); 7278 7279 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc, 7280 Context.DependentTy, 7281 VK_LValue, 7282 OK_Ordinary, 7283 Context.DependentTy, 7284 Context.DependentTy, 7285 OpLoc)); 7286 } 7287 7288 // FIXME: save results of ADL from here? 7289 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators 7290 // TODO: provide better source location info in DNLoc component. 7291 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc); 7292 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn 7293 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, /*Dependent*/ true, NamingClass, 7294 0, SourceRange(), OpNameInfo, 7295 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns), 7296 Fns.begin(), Fns.end()); 7297 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn, 7298 Args, 2, 7299 Context.DependentTy, 7300 VK_RValue, 7301 OpLoc)); 7302 } 7303 7304 // Always do property rvalue conversions on the RHS. 7305 if (Args[1]->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) 7306 ConvertPropertyForRValue(Args[1]); 7307 7308 // The LHS is more complicated. 7309 if (Args[0]->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) { 7310 7311 // There's a tension for assignment operators between primitive 7312 // property assignment and the overloaded operators. 7313 if (BinaryOperator::isAssignmentOp(Opc)) { 7314 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr *PRE = LHS->getObjCProperty(); 7315 7316 // Is the property "logically" settable? 7317 bool Settable = (PRE->isExplicitProperty() || 7318 PRE->getImplicitPropertySetter()); 7319 7320 // To avoid gratuitously inventing semantics, use the primitive 7321 // unless it isn't. Thoughts in case we ever really care: 7322 // - If the property isn't logically settable, we have to 7323 // load and hope. 7324 // - If the property is settable and this is simple assignment, 7325 // we really should use the primitive. 7326 // - If the property is settable, then we could try overloading 7327 // on a generic lvalue of the appropriate type; if it works 7328 // out to a builtin candidate, we would do that same operation 7329 // on the property, and otherwise just error. 7330 if (Settable) 7331 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]); 7332 } 7333 7334 ConvertPropertyForRValue(Args[0]); 7335 } 7336 7337 // If this is the assignment operator, we only perform overload resolution 7338 // if the left-hand side is a class or enumeration type. This is actually 7339 // a hack. The standard requires that we do overload resolution between the 7340 // various built-in candidates, but as DR507 points out, this can lead to 7341 // problems. So we do it this way, which pretty much follows what GCC does. 7342 // Note that we go the traditional code path for compound assignment forms. 7343 if (Opc == BO_Assign && !Args[0]->getType()->isOverloadableType()) 7344 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]); 7345 7346 // If this is the .* operator, which is not overloadable, just 7347 // create a built-in binary operator. 7348 if (Opc == BO_PtrMemD) 7349 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]); 7350 7351 // Build an empty overload set. 7352 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc); 7353 7354 // Add the candidates from the given function set. 7355 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, Args, 2, CandidateSet, false); 7356 7357 // Add operator candidates that are member functions. 7358 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 7359 7360 // Add candidates from ADL. 7361 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true, 7362 Args, 2, 7363 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0, 7364 CandidateSet); 7365 7366 // Add builtin operator candidates. 7367 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 7368 7369 // Perform overload resolution. 7370 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 7371 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) { 7372 case OR_Success: { 7373 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator. 7374 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function; 7375 7376 if (FnDecl) { 7377 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that 7378 // operator. 7379 7380 // Convert the arguments. 7381 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) { 7382 // Best->Access is only meaningful for class members. 7383 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl); 7384 7385 ExprResult Arg1 7386 = PerformCopyInitialization( 7387 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 7388 Context, 7389 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)), 7390 SourceLocation(), 7391 Owned(Args[1])); 7392 if (Arg1.isInvalid()) 7393 return ExprError(); 7394 7395 if (PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0, 7396 Best->FoundDecl, Method)) 7397 return ExprError(); 7398 7399 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>(); 7400 } else { 7401 // Convert the arguments. 7402 ExprResult Arg0 7403 = PerformCopyInitialization( 7404 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 7405 Context, 7406 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)), 7407 SourceLocation(), 7408 Owned(Args[0])); 7409 if (Arg0.isInvalid()) 7410 return ExprError(); 7411 7412 ExprResult Arg1 7413 = PerformCopyInitialization( 7414 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 7415 Context, 7416 FnDecl->getParamDecl(1)), 7417 SourceLocation(), 7418 Owned(Args[1])); 7419 if (Arg1.isInvalid()) 7420 return ExprError(); 7421 Args[0] = LHS = Arg0.takeAs<Expr>(); 7422 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>(); 7423 } 7424 7425 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc); 7426 7427 // Determine the result type. 7428 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType(); 7429 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 7430 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 7431 7432 // Build the actual expression node. 7433 Expr *FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, OpLoc); 7434 7435 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = 7436 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr, 7437 Args, 2, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc); 7438 7439 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall, 7440 FnDecl)) 7441 return ExprError(); 7442 7443 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 7444 } else { 7445 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then 7446 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in 7447 // operator node. 7448 if (PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0], 7449 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing) || 7450 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1], 7451 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing)) 7452 return ExprError(); 7453 7454 break; 7455 } 7456 } 7457 7458 case OR_No_Viable_Function: { 7459 // C++ [over.match.oper]p9: 7460 // If the operator is the operator , [...] and there are no 7461 // viable functions, then the operator is assumed to be the 7462 // built-in operator and interpreted according to clause 5. 7463 if (Opc == BO_Comma) 7464 break; 7465 7466 // For class as left operand for assignment or compound assigment operator 7467 // do not fall through to handling in built-in, but report that no overloaded 7468 // assignment operator found 7469 ExprResult Result = ExprError(); 7470 if (Args[0]->getType()->isRecordType() && 7471 Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign) { 7472 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper) 7473 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 7474 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 7475 } else { 7476 // No viable function; try to create a built-in operation, which will 7477 // produce an error. Then, show the non-viable candidates. 7478 Result = CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]); 7479 } 7480 assert(Result.isInvalid() && 7481 "C++ binary operator overloading is missing candidates!"); 7482 if (Result.isInvalid()) 7483 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2, 7484 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc); 7485 return move(Result); 7486 } 7487 7488 case OR_Ambiguous: 7489 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary) 7490 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 7491 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType() 7492 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 7493 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, 2, 7494 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc); 7495 return ExprError(); 7496 7497 case OR_Deleted: 7498 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper) 7499 << Best->Function->isDeleted() 7500 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 7501 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 7502 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2); 7503 return ExprError(); 7504 } 7505 7506 // We matched a built-in operator; build it. 7507 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]); 7508} 7509 7510ExprResult 7511Sema::CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(SourceLocation LLoc, 7512 SourceLocation RLoc, 7513 Expr *Base, Expr *Idx) { 7514 Expr *Args[2] = { Base, Idx }; 7515 DeclarationName OpName = 7516 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Subscript); 7517 7518 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent 7519 // expression. 7520 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) { 7521 7522 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators 7523 // CHECKME: no 'operator' keyword? 7524 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, LLoc); 7525 OpNameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc)); 7526 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn 7527 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, /*Dependent*/ true, NamingClass, 7528 0, SourceRange(), OpNameInfo, 7529 /*ADL*/ true, /*Overloaded*/ false, 7530 UnresolvedSetIterator(), 7531 UnresolvedSetIterator()); 7532 // Can't add any actual overloads yet 7533 7534 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript, Fn, 7535 Args, 2, 7536 Context.DependentTy, 7537 VK_RValue, 7538 RLoc)); 7539 } 7540 7541 if (Args[0]->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) 7542 ConvertPropertyForRValue(Args[0]); 7543 if (Args[1]->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) 7544 ConvertPropertyForRValue(Args[1]); 7545 7546 // Build an empty overload set. 7547 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LLoc); 7548 7549 // Subscript can only be overloaded as a member function. 7550 7551 // Add operator candidates that are member functions. 7552 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 7553 7554 // Add builtin operator candidates. 7555 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 7556 7557 // Perform overload resolution. 7558 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 7559 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, LLoc, Best)) { 7560 case OR_Success: { 7561 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator. 7562 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function; 7563 7564 if (FnDecl) { 7565 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that 7566 // operator. 7567 7568 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl); 7569 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LLoc); 7570 7571 // Convert the arguments. 7572 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl); 7573 if (PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0, 7574 Best->FoundDecl, Method)) 7575 return ExprError(); 7576 7577 // Convert the arguments. 7578 ExprResult InputInit 7579 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 7580 Context, 7581 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)), 7582 SourceLocation(), 7583 Owned(Args[1])); 7584 if (InputInit.isInvalid()) 7585 return ExprError(); 7586 7587 Args[1] = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>(); 7588 7589 // Determine the result type 7590 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType(); 7591 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 7592 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 7593 7594 // Build the actual expression node. 7595 Expr *FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, LLoc); 7596 7597 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = 7598 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript, 7599 FnExpr, Args, 2, 7600 ResultTy, VK, RLoc); 7601 7602 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), LLoc, TheCall, 7603 FnDecl)) 7604 return ExprError(); 7605 7606 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 7607 } else { 7608 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then 7609 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in 7610 // operator node. 7611 if (PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0], 7612 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing) || 7613 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1], 7614 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing)) 7615 return ExprError(); 7616 7617 break; 7618 } 7619 } 7620 7621 case OR_No_Viable_Function: { 7622 if (CandidateSet.empty()) 7623 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_oper) 7624 << Args[0]->getType() << /*subscript*/ 0 7625 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 7626 else 7627 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_subscript) 7628 << Args[0]->getType() 7629 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 7630 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2, 7631 "[]", LLoc); 7632 return ExprError(); 7633 } 7634 7635 case OR_Ambiguous: 7636 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary) 7637 << "[]" 7638 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType() 7639 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 7640 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, 2, 7641 "[]", LLoc); 7642 return ExprError(); 7643 7644 case OR_Deleted: 7645 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper) 7646 << Best->Function->isDeleted() << "[]" 7647 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 7648 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2, 7649 "[]", LLoc); 7650 return ExprError(); 7651 } 7652 7653 // We matched a built-in operator; build it. 7654 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Args[0], LLoc, Args[1], RLoc); 7655} 7656 7657/// BuildCallToMemberFunction - Build a call to a member 7658/// function. MemExpr is the expression that refers to the member 7659/// function (and includes the object parameter), Args/NumArgs are the 7660/// arguments to the function call (not including the object 7661/// parameter). The caller needs to validate that the member 7662/// expression refers to a member function or an overloaded member 7663/// function. 7664ExprResult 7665Sema::BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope *S, Expr *MemExprE, 7666 SourceLocation LParenLoc, Expr **Args, 7667 unsigned NumArgs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 7668 // Dig out the member expression. This holds both the object 7669 // argument and the member function we're referring to. 7670 Expr *NakedMemExpr = MemExprE->IgnoreParens(); 7671 7672 MemberExpr *MemExpr; 7673 CXXMethodDecl *Method = 0; 7674 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_public); 7675 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0; 7676 if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) { 7677 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr); 7678 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemExpr->getMemberDecl()); 7679 FoundDecl = MemExpr->getFoundDecl(); 7680 Qualifier = MemExpr->getQualifier(); 7681 } else { 7682 UnresolvedMemberExpr *UnresExpr = cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr); 7683 Qualifier = UnresExpr->getQualifier(); 7684 7685 QualType ObjectType = UnresExpr->getBaseType(); 7686 7687 // Add overload candidates 7688 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc()); 7689 7690 // FIXME: avoid copy. 7691 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0; 7692 if (UnresExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 7693 UnresExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer); 7694 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer; 7695 } 7696 7697 for (UnresolvedMemberExpr::decls_iterator I = UnresExpr->decls_begin(), 7698 E = UnresExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) { 7699 7700 NamedDecl *Func = *I; 7701 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext()); 7702 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)) 7703 Func = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)->getTargetDecl(); 7704 7705 if ((Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func))) { 7706 // If explicit template arguments were provided, we can't call a 7707 // non-template member function. 7708 if (TemplateArgs) 7709 continue; 7710 7711 AddMethodCandidate(Method, I.getPair(), ActingDC, ObjectType, 7712 Args, NumArgs, 7713 CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false); 7714 } else { 7715 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Func), 7716 I.getPair(), ActingDC, TemplateArgs, 7717 ObjectType, Args, NumArgs, 7718 CandidateSet, 7719 /*SuppressUsedConversions=*/false); 7720 } 7721 } 7722 7723 DeclarationName DeclName = UnresExpr->getMemberName(); 7724 7725 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 7726 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UnresExpr->getLocStart(), 7727 Best)) { 7728 case OR_Success: 7729 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function); 7730 FoundDecl = Best->FoundDecl; 7731 CheckUnresolvedMemberAccess(UnresExpr, Best->FoundDecl); 7732 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, UnresExpr->getNameLoc()); 7733 break; 7734 7735 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 7736 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), 7737 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call) 7738 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange(); 7739 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs); 7740 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions! 7741 return ExprError(); 7742 7743 case OR_Ambiguous: 7744 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_member_call) 7745 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange(); 7746 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs); 7747 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions! 7748 return ExprError(); 7749 7750 case OR_Deleted: 7751 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_member_call) 7752 << Best->Function->isDeleted() 7753 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange(); 7754 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs); 7755 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions! 7756 return ExprError(); 7757 } 7758 7759 MemExprE = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(MemExprE, FoundDecl, Method); 7760 7761 // If overload resolution picked a static member, build a 7762 // non-member call based on that function. 7763 if (Method->isStatic()) { 7764 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(MemExprE, Method, LParenLoc, 7765 Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc); 7766 } 7767 7768 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(MemExprE->IgnoreParens()); 7769 } 7770 7771 QualType ResultType = Method->getResultType(); 7772 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultType); 7773 ResultType = ResultType.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 7774 7775 assert(Method && "Member call to something that isn't a method?"); 7776 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall = 7777 new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args, NumArgs, 7778 ResultType, VK, RParenLoc); 7779 7780 // Check for a valid return type. 7781 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), MemExpr->getMemberLoc(), 7782 TheCall, Method)) 7783 return ExprError(); 7784 7785 // Convert the object argument (for a non-static member function call). 7786 // We only need to do this if there was actually an overload; otherwise 7787 // it was done at lookup. 7788 Expr *ObjectArg = MemExpr->getBase(); 7789 if (!Method->isStatic() && 7790 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(ObjectArg, Qualifier, 7791 FoundDecl, Method)) 7792 return ExprError(); 7793 MemExpr->setBase(ObjectArg); 7794 7795 // Convert the rest of the arguments 7796 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 7797 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, MemExpr, Method, Proto, Args, NumArgs, 7798 RParenLoc)) 7799 return ExprError(); 7800 7801 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall)) 7802 return ExprError(); 7803 7804 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 7805} 7806 7807/// BuildCallToObjectOfClassType - Build a call to an object of class 7808/// type (C++ [over.call.object]), which can end up invoking an 7809/// overloaded function call operator (@c operator()) or performing a 7810/// user-defined conversion on the object argument. 7811ExprResult 7812Sema::BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope *S, Expr *Object, 7813 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 7814 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs, 7815 SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 7816 if (Object->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) 7817 ConvertPropertyForRValue(Object); 7818 7819 assert(Object->getType()->isRecordType() && "Requires object type argument"); 7820 const RecordType *Record = Object->getType()->getAs<RecordType>(); 7821 7822 // C++ [over.call.object]p1: 7823 // If the primary-expression E in the function call syntax 7824 // evaluates to a class object of type "cv T", then the set of 7825 // candidate functions includes at least the function call 7826 // operators of T. The function call operators of T are obtained by 7827 // ordinary lookup of the name operator() in the context of 7828 // (E).operator(). 7829 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LParenLoc); 7830 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call); 7831 7832 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Object->getType(), 7833 PDiag(diag::err_incomplete_object_call) 7834 << Object->getSourceRange())) 7835 return true; 7836 7837 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, LParenLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 7838 LookupQualifiedName(R, Record->getDecl()); 7839 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 7840 7841 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end(); 7842 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) { 7843 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Object->getType(), 7844 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet, 7845 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/ false); 7846 } 7847 7848 // C++ [over.call.object]p2: 7849 // In addition, for each conversion function declared in T of the 7850 // form 7851 // 7852 // operator conversion-type-id () cv-qualifier; 7853 // 7854 // where cv-qualifier is the same cv-qualification as, or a 7855 // greater cv-qualification than, cv, and where conversion-type-id 7856 // denotes the type "pointer to function of (P1,...,Pn) returning 7857 // R", or the type "reference to pointer to function of 7858 // (P1,...,Pn) returning R", or the type "reference to function 7859 // of (P1,...,Pn) returning R", a surrogate call function [...] 7860 // is also considered as a candidate function. Similarly, 7861 // surrogate call functions are added to the set of candidate 7862 // functions for each conversion function declared in an 7863 // accessible base class provided the function is not hidden 7864 // within T by another intervening declaration. 7865 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions 7866 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 7867 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(), 7868 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) { 7869 NamedDecl *D = *I; 7870 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext()); 7871 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 7872 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 7873 7874 // Skip over templated conversion functions; they aren't 7875 // surrogates. 7876 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)) 7877 continue; 7878 7879 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 7880 7881 // Strip the reference type (if any) and then the pointer type (if 7882 // any) to get down to what might be a function type. 7883 QualType ConvType = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 7884 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>()) 7885 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType(); 7886 7887 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 7888 AddSurrogateCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingContext, Proto, 7889 Object->getType(), Args, NumArgs, 7890 CandidateSet); 7891 } 7892 7893 // Perform overload resolution. 7894 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 7895 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Object->getLocStart(), 7896 Best)) { 7897 case OR_Success: 7898 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the appropriate call 7899 // below. 7900 break; 7901 7902 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 7903 if (CandidateSet.empty()) 7904 Diag(Object->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_ovl_no_oper) 7905 << Object->getType() << /*call*/ 1 7906 << Object->getSourceRange(); 7907 else 7908 Diag(Object->getSourceRange().getBegin(), 7909 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_object_call) 7910 << Object->getType() << Object->getSourceRange(); 7911 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs); 7912 break; 7913 7914 case OR_Ambiguous: 7915 Diag(Object->getSourceRange().getBegin(), 7916 diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_object_call) 7917 << Object->getType() << Object->getSourceRange(); 7918 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, NumArgs); 7919 break; 7920 7921 case OR_Deleted: 7922 Diag(Object->getSourceRange().getBegin(), 7923 diag::err_ovl_deleted_object_call) 7924 << Best->Function->isDeleted() 7925 << Object->getType() << Object->getSourceRange(); 7926 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs); 7927 break; 7928 } 7929 7930 if (Best == CandidateSet.end()) 7931 return true; 7932 7933 if (Best->Function == 0) { 7934 // Since there is no function declaration, this is one of the 7935 // surrogate candidates. Dig out the conversion function. 7936 CXXConversionDecl *Conv 7937 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>( 7938 Best->Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction); 7939 7940 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object, 0, Best->FoundDecl); 7941 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc); 7942 7943 // We selected one of the surrogate functions that converts the 7944 // object parameter to a function pointer. Perform the conversion 7945 // on the object argument, then let ActOnCallExpr finish the job. 7946 7947 // Create an implicit member expr to refer to the conversion operator. 7948 // and then call it. 7949 CXXMemberCallExpr *CE = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(Object, Best->FoundDecl, 7950 Conv); 7951 7952 return ActOnCallExpr(S, CE, LParenLoc, MultiExprArg(Args, NumArgs), 7953 RParenLoc); 7954 } 7955 7956 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object, 0, Best->FoundDecl); 7957 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc); 7958 7959 // We found an overloaded operator(). Build a CXXOperatorCallExpr 7960 // that calls this method, using Object for the implicit object 7961 // parameter and passing along the remaining arguments. 7962 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function); 7963 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 7964 7965 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs(); 7966 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs; 7967 7968 // Build the full argument list for the method call (the 7969 // implicit object parameter is placed at the beginning of the 7970 // list). 7971 Expr **MethodArgs; 7972 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) { 7973 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto; 7974 MethodArgs = new Expr*[NumArgsInProto + 1]; 7975 } else { 7976 MethodArgs = new Expr*[NumArgs + 1]; 7977 } 7978 MethodArgs[0] = Object; 7979 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) 7980 MethodArgs[ArgIdx + 1] = Args[ArgIdx]; 7981 7982 Expr *NewFn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method); 7983 7984 // Once we've built TheCall, all of the expressions are properly 7985 // owned. 7986 QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType(); 7987 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 7988 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 7989 7990 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = 7991 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Call, NewFn, 7992 MethodArgs, NumArgs + 1, 7993 ResultTy, VK, RParenLoc); 7994 delete [] MethodArgs; 7995 7996 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), LParenLoc, TheCall, 7997 Method)) 7998 return true; 7999 8000 // We may have default arguments. If so, we need to allocate more 8001 // slots in the call for them. 8002 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) 8003 TheCall->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto + 1); 8004 else if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) 8005 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto; 8006 8007 bool IsError = false; 8008 8009 // Initialize the implicit object parameter. 8010 IsError |= PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Object, /*Qualifier=*/0, 8011 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 8012 TheCall->setArg(0, Object); 8013 8014 8015 // Check the argument types. 8016 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) { 8017 Expr *Arg; 8018 if (i < NumArgs) { 8019 Arg = Args[i]; 8020 8021 // Pass the argument. 8022 8023 ExprResult InputInit 8024 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 8025 Context, 8026 Method->getParamDecl(i)), 8027 SourceLocation(), Arg); 8028 8029 IsError |= InputInit.isInvalid(); 8030 Arg = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>(); 8031 } else { 8032 ExprResult DefArg 8033 = BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(LParenLoc, Method, Method->getParamDecl(i)); 8034 if (DefArg.isInvalid()) { 8035 IsError = true; 8036 break; 8037 } 8038 8039 Arg = DefArg.takeAs<Expr>(); 8040 } 8041 8042 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg); 8043 } 8044 8045 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...". 8046 if (Proto->isVariadic()) { 8047 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7). 8048 for (unsigned i = NumArgsInProto; i != NumArgs; i++) { 8049 Expr *Arg = Args[i]; 8050 IsError |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, VariadicMethod, 0); 8051 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg); 8052 } 8053 } 8054 8055 if (IsError) return true; 8056 8057 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall)) 8058 return true; 8059 8060 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 8061} 8062 8063/// BuildOverloadedArrowExpr - Build a call to an overloaded @c operator-> 8064/// (if one exists), where @c Base is an expression of class type and 8065/// @c Member is the name of the member we're trying to find. 8066ExprResult 8067Sema::BuildOverloadedArrowExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc) { 8068 assert(Base->getType()->isRecordType() && "left-hand side must have class type"); 8069 8070 if (Base->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) 8071 ConvertPropertyForRValue(Base); 8072 8073 SourceLocation Loc = Base->getExprLoc(); 8074 8075 // C++ [over.ref]p1: 8076 // 8077 // [...] An expression x->m is interpreted as (x.operator->())->m 8078 // for a class object x of type T if T::operator->() exists and if 8079 // the operator is selected as the best match function by the 8080 // overload resolution mechanism (13.3). 8081 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Arrow); 8082 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc); 8083 const RecordType *BaseRecord = Base->getType()->getAs<RecordType>(); 8084 8085 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, Base->getType(), 8086 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag) 8087 << Base->getSourceRange())) 8088 return ExprError(); 8089 8090 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 8091 LookupQualifiedName(R, BaseRecord->getDecl()); 8092 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 8093 8094 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end(); 8095 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) { 8096 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Base->getType(), 0, 0, CandidateSet, 8097 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false); 8098 } 8099 8100 // Perform overload resolution. 8101 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 8102 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) { 8103 case OR_Success: 8104 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the call below. 8105 break; 8106 8107 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 8108 if (CandidateSet.empty()) 8109 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow) 8110 << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange(); 8111 else 8112 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper) 8113 << "operator->" << Base->getSourceRange(); 8114 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, &Base, 1); 8115 return ExprError(); 8116 8117 case OR_Ambiguous: 8118 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary) 8119 << "->" << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange(); 8120 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, &Base, 1); 8121 return ExprError(); 8122 8123 case OR_Deleted: 8124 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper) 8125 << Best->Function->isDeleted() 8126 << "->" << Base->getSourceRange(); 8127 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, &Base, 1); 8128 return ExprError(); 8129 } 8130 8131 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Base, 0, Best->FoundDecl); 8132 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc); 8133 8134 // Convert the object parameter. 8135 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function); 8136 if (PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Base, /*Qualifier=*/0, 8137 Best->FoundDecl, Method)) 8138 return ExprError(); 8139 8140 // Build the operator call. 8141 Expr *FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method); 8142 8143 QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType(); 8144 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 8145 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 8146 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = 8147 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Arrow, FnExpr, 8148 &Base, 1, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc); 8149 8150 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall, 8151 Method)) 8152 return ExprError(); 8153 return Owned(TheCall); 8154} 8155 8156/// FixOverloadedFunctionReference - E is an expression that refers to 8157/// a C++ overloaded function (possibly with some parentheses and 8158/// perhaps a '&' around it). We have resolved the overloaded function 8159/// to the function declaration Fn, so patch up the expression E to 8160/// refer (possibly indirectly) to Fn. Returns the new expr. 8161Expr *Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair Found, 8162 FunctionDecl *Fn) { 8163 if (ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) { 8164 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(PE->getSubExpr(), 8165 Found, Fn); 8166 if (SubExpr == PE->getSubExpr()) 8167 return PE; 8168 8169 return new (Context) ParenExpr(PE->getLParen(), PE->getRParen(), SubExpr); 8170 } 8171 8172 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) { 8173 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ICE->getSubExpr(), 8174 Found, Fn); 8175 assert(Context.hasSameType(ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(), 8176 SubExpr->getType()) && 8177 "Implicit cast type cannot be determined from overload"); 8178 assert(ICE->path_empty() && "fixing up hierarchy conversion?"); 8179 if (SubExpr == ICE->getSubExpr()) 8180 return ICE; 8181 8182 return ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, ICE->getType(), 8183 ICE->getCastKind(), 8184 SubExpr, 0, 8185 ICE->getValueKind()); 8186 } 8187 8188 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) { 8189 assert(UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf && 8190 "Can only take the address of an overloaded function"); 8191 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) { 8192 if (Method->isStatic()) { 8193 // Do nothing: static member functions aren't any different 8194 // from non-member functions. 8195 } else { 8196 // Fix the sub expression, which really has to be an 8197 // UnresolvedLookupExpr holding an overloaded member function 8198 // or template. 8199 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(), 8200 Found, Fn); 8201 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr()) 8202 return UnOp; 8203 8204 assert(isa<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr) 8205 && "fixed to something other than a decl ref"); 8206 assert(cast<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)->getQualifier() 8207 && "fixed to a member ref with no nested name qualifier"); 8208 8209 // We have taken the address of a pointer to member 8210 // function. Perform the computation here so that we get the 8211 // appropriate pointer to member type. 8212 QualType ClassType 8213 = Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Method->getDeclContext())); 8214 QualType MemPtrType 8215 = Context.getMemberPointerType(Fn->getType(), ClassType.getTypePtr()); 8216 8217 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, MemPtrType, 8218 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, 8219 UnOp->getOperatorLoc()); 8220 } 8221 } 8222 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(), 8223 Found, Fn); 8224 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr()) 8225 return UnOp; 8226 8227 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, 8228 Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()), 8229 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, 8230 UnOp->getOperatorLoc()); 8231 } 8232 8233 if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) { 8234 // FIXME: avoid copy. 8235 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0; 8236 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 8237 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer); 8238 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer; 8239 } 8240 8241 return DeclRefExpr::Create(Context, 8242 ULE->getQualifier(), 8243 ULE->getQualifierRange(), 8244 Fn, 8245 ULE->getNameLoc(), 8246 Fn->getType(), 8247 VK_LValue, 8248 TemplateArgs); 8249 } 8250 8251 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(E)) { 8252 // FIXME: avoid copy. 8253 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0; 8254 if (MemExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 8255 MemExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer); 8256 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer; 8257 } 8258 8259 Expr *Base; 8260 8261 // If we're filling in a static method where we used to have an 8262 // implicit member access, rewrite to a simple decl ref. 8263 if (MemExpr->isImplicitAccess()) { 8264 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) { 8265 return DeclRefExpr::Create(Context, 8266 MemExpr->getQualifier(), 8267 MemExpr->getQualifierRange(), 8268 Fn, 8269 MemExpr->getMemberLoc(), 8270 Fn->getType(), 8271 VK_LValue, 8272 TemplateArgs); 8273 } else { 8274 SourceLocation Loc = MemExpr->getMemberLoc(); 8275 if (MemExpr->getQualifier()) 8276 Loc = MemExpr->getQualifierRange().getBegin(); 8277 Base = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, 8278 MemExpr->getBaseType(), 8279 /*isImplicit=*/true); 8280 } 8281 } else 8282 Base = MemExpr->getBase(); 8283 8284 return MemberExpr::Create(Context, Base, 8285 MemExpr->isArrow(), 8286 MemExpr->getQualifier(), 8287 MemExpr->getQualifierRange(), 8288 Fn, 8289 Found, 8290 MemExpr->getMemberNameInfo(), 8291 TemplateArgs, 8292 Fn->getType(), 8293 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic() 8294 ? VK_LValue : VK_RValue, 8295 OK_Ordinary); 8296 } 8297 8298 llvm_unreachable("Invalid reference to overloaded function"); 8299 return E; 8300} 8301 8302ExprResult Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ExprResult E, 8303 DeclAccessPair Found, 8304 FunctionDecl *Fn) { 8305 return Owned(FixOverloadedFunctionReference((Expr *)E.get(), Found, Fn)); 8306} 8307 8308} // end namespace clang 8309